1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
3 @c 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009,
4 @c 2010, 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
104 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
105 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
106 software in general. We will miss him.
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
164 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
167 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
168 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
171 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
172 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
175 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
176 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
177 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
178 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
179 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
181 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
183 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
184 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
185 how you can copy and share GDB
186 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
195 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
197 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
198 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
199 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
201 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
202 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
206 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
209 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
212 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
215 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
216 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
219 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
220 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
221 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
223 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
227 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
228 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
230 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
231 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
234 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
235 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
236 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
240 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
241 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
244 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
245 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
248 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
249 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
253 @unnumberedsec Free Software
255 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
256 General Public License
257 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
258 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
259 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
260 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
261 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
262 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
264 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
265 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
268 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
270 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
271 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
272 include with the free software. Many of our most important
273 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
274 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
275 when an important free software package does not come with a free
276 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
279 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
280 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
281 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
282 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
283 them from the free software world.
285 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
286 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
287 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
288 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
289 contract to make it non-free.
291 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
292 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
293 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
294 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
295 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
296 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
297 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
299 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
300 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
301 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
302 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
304 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
305 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
306 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
307 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
308 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
309 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
312 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
313 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
314 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
315 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
316 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
317 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
318 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
319 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
322 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
323 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
324 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
325 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
326 manual to replace it.
328 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
329 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
330 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
331 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
332 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
333 the free software community.
335 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
336 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
337 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
338 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
339 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
340 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
341 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
342 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
343 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
345 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
346 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
347 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
348 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
349 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
350 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
351 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
352 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
354 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
355 published by other publishers, at
356 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
359 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
361 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
362 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
363 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
364 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
365 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
366 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
367 blow-by-blow account.
369 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
372 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
373 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
374 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
377 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
378 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
380 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
381 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
382 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
383 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
384 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
385 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
386 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
387 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
388 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
390 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
391 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
393 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
394 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
395 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
396 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
397 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
399 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
400 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
401 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
403 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
404 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
406 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
408 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
409 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
411 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
412 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
413 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
414 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
415 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
416 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
417 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
418 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
419 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
420 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
421 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
422 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
423 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
424 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
425 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
426 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
428 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
430 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
433 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
434 about several machine instruction sets.
436 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
437 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
438 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
439 and RDI targets, respectively.
441 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
442 command-line editing and command history.
444 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
445 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
447 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
448 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
451 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
452 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
454 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
456 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
459 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
461 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
463 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
465 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
468 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
470 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
472 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
473 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
475 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
476 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
477 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
478 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
479 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
480 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
481 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
483 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
484 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
486 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
487 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
488 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
489 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
490 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
491 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
492 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
493 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
494 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
495 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
496 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
497 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
498 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
499 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
500 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
502 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
503 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
505 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
508 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
509 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
510 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
511 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
512 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
513 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
515 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
516 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
517 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
518 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
519 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
520 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
521 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
522 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
523 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
524 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
525 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
528 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
529 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
530 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
531 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
533 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
534 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
537 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
539 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
540 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
541 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
544 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
545 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
548 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
549 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
551 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
552 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
553 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
554 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
555 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
556 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
557 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
558 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
559 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
572 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
574 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
577 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
581 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
584 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
585 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
586 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
587 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
588 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
590 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
593 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
598 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
599 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
600 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
601 that examples fit in this manual.
604 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
608 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
609 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
610 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
611 @code{break} command.
614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
615 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
619 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
620 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
621 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
624 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
625 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
633 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
634 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
635 context where it stops.
638 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
640 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
642 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
646 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
647 the next line of the current function.
651 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
656 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
657 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
658 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
659 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
663 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
665 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
669 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
670 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
671 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
672 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
673 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
674 stack frame for each active subroutine.
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
678 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
680 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
682 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
683 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
685 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
686 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
690 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
691 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
692 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
696 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
698 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
699 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
701 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
704 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
708 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
709 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
710 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
711 (@code{print}) to see their values.
714 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
715 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
717 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
721 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
722 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
723 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
729 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
731 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
734 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
735 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
742 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
743 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
747 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
752 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
757 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
758 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
759 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
760 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
761 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
767 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
772 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
773 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
774 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
775 example that caused trouble initially:
781 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
788 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
789 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
790 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
794 Program exited normally.
798 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
799 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
800 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
803 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
807 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
809 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
813 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
815 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
819 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
820 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
821 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
822 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
826 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
828 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
829 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
831 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
832 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
834 The command-line options described here are designed
835 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
836 options may effectively be unavailable.
838 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
839 specifying an executable program:
842 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
846 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
853 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
854 to debug a running process:
857 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
861 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
862 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
864 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
865 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
866 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
867 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
868 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
870 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
871 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
874 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
876 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
877 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
879 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
880 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
887 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
888 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
899 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
901 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
902 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
903 @samp{-x} option is used.
907 * File Options:: Choosing files
908 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
909 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
913 @subsection Choosing Files
915 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
916 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
917 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
918 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
919 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
920 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
921 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
922 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
923 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
924 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
925 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
926 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
927 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
929 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
930 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
931 argument and ignore it.
933 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
934 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
935 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
936 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
937 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
939 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
940 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
944 @item -symbols @var{file}
946 @cindex @code{--symbols}
948 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
950 @item -exec @var{file}
952 @cindex @code{--exec}
954 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
955 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
959 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
962 @item -core @var{file}
964 @cindex @code{--core}
966 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
968 @item -pid @var{number}
969 @itemx -p @var{number}
972 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
974 @item -command @var{file}
976 @cindex @code{--command}
978 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
979 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
980 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
982 @item -eval-command @var{command}
983 @itemx -ex @var{command}
984 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
986 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
988 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
989 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
992 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
993 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
996 @item -directory @var{directory}
997 @itemx -d @var{directory}
998 @cindex @code{--directory}
1000 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1004 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1006 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1007 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1008 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1013 @subsection Choosing Modes
1015 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1016 batch mode or quiet mode.
1023 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1024 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1025 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1031 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1032 @cindex @code{--silent}
1034 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1035 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1038 @cindex @code{--batch}
1039 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1040 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1041 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1042 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1043 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1044 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1045 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1047 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1048 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1049 make this more useful, the message
1052 Program exited normally.
1056 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1057 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1061 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1062 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1063 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1064 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1065 for an interactive session.
1067 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1068 messages, for example.
1070 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1071 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1073 @item -return-child-result
1074 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1075 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1076 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1080 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1081 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1082 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1084 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1086 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1087 the exit code will be -1.
1090 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1091 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1096 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1098 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1099 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1100 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1104 @cindex @code{--windows}
1106 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1109 @item -cd @var{directory}
1111 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1112 instead of the current directory.
1114 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1115 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1116 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1117 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1118 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1122 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1124 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1125 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1126 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1127 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1128 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1129 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1130 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1131 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1135 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1136 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1137 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1138 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1141 @item -annotate @var{level}
1142 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1143 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1144 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1145 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1146 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1147 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1148 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1149 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1150 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1152 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1156 @cindex @code{--args}
1157 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1158 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1159 This option stops option processing.
1161 @item -baud @var{bps}
1163 @cindex @code{--baud}
1165 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1166 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1168 @item -l @var{timeout}
1170 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1171 for remote debugging.
1173 @item -tty @var{device}
1174 @itemx -t @var{device}
1175 @cindex @code{--tty}
1177 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1178 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1180 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1182 @cindex @code{--tui}
1183 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1184 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1185 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1186 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1187 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1188 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1189 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1192 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1193 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1194 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1195 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1198 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1199 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1200 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1201 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1202 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1203 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1205 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1206 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1207 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1208 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1209 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1210 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1213 @cindex @code{--write}
1214 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1215 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1219 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1220 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1221 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1224 @cindex @code{--version}
1225 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1226 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1231 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1232 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1234 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1238 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1239 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1243 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1244 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1245 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1249 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1250 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1251 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1255 Processes command line options and operands.
1258 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1259 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1260 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1261 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1262 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1266 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1267 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1268 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1269 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1271 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1272 you must do something like the following:
1275 $ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" -ex "file myprogram"
1278 The following does not work because the auto-loading is turned off too late:
1281 $ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" myprogram
1285 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1286 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1289 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1290 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1291 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1294 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1295 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1296 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1297 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1298 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1299 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1301 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1302 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1304 @cindex init file name
1305 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1306 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1307 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1308 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1309 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1310 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1311 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1312 the file to the standard name.
1316 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1317 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1318 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1321 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1322 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1323 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1325 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1326 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1327 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1328 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1333 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1334 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1335 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1336 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1337 until a time when it is safe.
1339 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1340 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1341 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1343 @node Shell Commands
1344 @section Shell Commands
1346 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1347 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1348 just use the @code{shell} command.
1352 @cindex shell escape
1353 @item shell @var{command string}
1354 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1355 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1356 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1357 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1360 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1361 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1366 @cindex calling make
1367 @item make @var{make-args}
1368 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1369 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1372 @node Logging Output
1373 @section Logging Output
1374 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1375 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1377 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1378 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1382 @item set logging on
1384 @item set logging off
1386 @cindex logging file name
1387 @item set logging file @var{file}
1388 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1389 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1390 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1391 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1392 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1393 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1394 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1395 @kindex show logging
1397 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1401 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1403 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1404 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1405 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1406 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1407 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1410 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1411 * Completion:: Command completion
1412 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1415 @node Command Syntax
1416 @section Command Syntax
1418 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1419 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1420 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1421 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1422 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1423 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1425 @cindex abbreviation
1426 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1427 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1428 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1429 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1430 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1431 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1432 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1434 @cindex repeating commands
1435 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1436 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1437 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1438 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1439 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1440 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1441 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1443 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1444 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1445 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1447 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1448 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1449 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1450 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1451 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1453 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1455 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1456 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1457 Files,,Command Files}).
1459 @cindex repeating command sequences
1460 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1461 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1462 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1463 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1467 @section Command Completion
1470 @cindex word completion
1471 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1472 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1473 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1474 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1476 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1477 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1478 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1479 enter it). For example, if you type
1481 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1482 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1483 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1484 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1486 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1490 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1491 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1494 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1498 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1499 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1500 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1501 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1502 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1503 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1505 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1506 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1507 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1508 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1509 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1510 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1511 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1512 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1516 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1517 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1518 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1519 make_abs_section make_function_type
1520 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1521 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1522 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1523 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1527 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1528 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1531 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1532 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1533 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1534 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1535 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1537 @cindex quotes in commands
1538 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1539 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1540 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1541 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1542 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1543 @value{GDBN} commands.
1545 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1546 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1547 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1548 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1549 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1550 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1551 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1552 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1553 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1554 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1555 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1558 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1559 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1560 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1563 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1564 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1565 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1569 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1570 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1571 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1575 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1576 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1577 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1579 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1580 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1581 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1582 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1584 @cindex completion of structure field names
1585 @cindex structure field name completion
1586 @cindex completion of union field names
1587 @cindex union field name completion
1588 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1589 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1590 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1591 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1592 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1596 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1597 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1598 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1602 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1603 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1610 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1611 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1612 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1613 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1614 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1615 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1616 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1617 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1624 @section Getting Help
1625 @cindex online documentation
1628 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1629 using the command @code{help}.
1632 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1635 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1636 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1640 List of classes of commands:
1642 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1643 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1644 data -- Examining data
1645 files -- Specifying and examining files
1646 internals -- Maintenance commands
1647 obscure -- Obscure features
1648 running -- Running the program
1649 stack -- Examining the stack
1650 status -- Status inquiries
1651 support -- Support facilities
1652 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1653 stopping the program
1654 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1656 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1657 commands in that class.
1658 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1660 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1663 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1665 @item help @var{class}
1666 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1667 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1668 help display for the class @code{status}:
1671 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1676 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1677 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1678 info -- Generic command for showing things
1679 about the program being debugged
1680 show -- Generic command for showing things
1683 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1685 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1689 @item help @var{command}
1690 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1691 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1694 @item apropos @var{args}
1695 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1696 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1697 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1708 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1709 multiple times in one run
1710 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1711 multiple times in one run
1716 @item complete @var{args}
1717 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1718 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1719 command you want completed. For example:
1725 @noindent results in:
1736 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1739 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1740 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1741 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1742 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1743 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1744 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1749 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1751 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1752 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1753 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1754 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1755 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1756 @w{@code{help info}}.
1760 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1761 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1762 @code{set prompt $}.
1766 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1767 @value{GDBN} itself.
1768 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1769 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1770 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1771 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1774 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1775 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1776 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1777 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1778 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1779 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1783 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1784 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1787 @kindex show version
1788 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1790 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1791 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1792 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1793 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1794 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1795 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1796 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1797 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1800 @kindex show copying
1801 @kindex info copying
1802 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1805 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1807 @kindex show warranty
1808 @kindex info warranty
1810 @itemx info warranty
1811 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1812 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1817 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1819 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1820 debugging information when you compile it.
1822 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1823 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1824 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1825 kill a child process.
1828 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1829 * Starting:: Starting your program
1830 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1831 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1833 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1834 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1835 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1836 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1838 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1839 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1840 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1841 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1845 @section Compiling for Debugging
1847 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1848 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1849 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1850 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1851 and addresses in the executable code.
1853 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1856 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1857 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1858 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1859 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1860 executables containing debugging information.
1862 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1863 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1864 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1865 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1866 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1868 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1869 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1870 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1872 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1873 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1874 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1875 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1876 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1877 provides macro information if you specify the options
1878 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1879 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1880 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1881 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1886 @section Starting your Program
1892 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1895 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1896 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1897 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1898 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1899 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1903 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1904 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1905 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1906 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1907 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1908 message like this one:
1911 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1912 Try "help target" or "continue".
1916 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1917 first (@pxref{load}).
1919 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1920 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1921 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1922 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1923 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1924 divided into four categories:
1927 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1928 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1929 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1930 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1931 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1933 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1934 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1935 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1937 @item The @emph{environment.}
1938 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1939 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1940 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1941 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1943 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1944 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1945 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1946 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1948 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1949 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1950 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1951 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1952 set a different device for your program.
1953 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1956 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1957 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1958 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1962 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1963 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1964 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1965 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1966 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1968 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1969 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1970 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1971 your current breakpoints.
1976 @cindex run to main procedure
1977 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1978 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1979 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1980 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1981 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1982 procedure, depending on the language used.
1984 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1985 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1986 the @samp{run} command.
1988 @cindex elaboration phase
1989 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1990 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1991 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1992 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1993 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1994 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1995 will remain to halt execution.
1997 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1998 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1999 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2000 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2001 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2003 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2004 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2005 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2006 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2007 elaboration code before running your program.
2009 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2010 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2011 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2012 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2013 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2014 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2015 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2016 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2017 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2018 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2019 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2021 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2022 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2023 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2024 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2026 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2027 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2031 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2035 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2036 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2038 @kindex set disable-randomization
2039 @item set disable-randomization
2040 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2041 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2042 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2043 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2044 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2046 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2050 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2053 @item set disable-randomization off
2054 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2055 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2056 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2057 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2058 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2059 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2061 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2062 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2063 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2064 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2065 a code at its expected addresses.
2067 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2068 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2069 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2070 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2071 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2072 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2073 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2074 a randomly chosen address.
2076 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2077 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2078 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2079 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2080 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2082 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2083 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2085 @item show disable-randomization
2086 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2087 the virtual address space of the started program.
2092 @section Your Program's Arguments
2094 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2095 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2097 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2098 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2099 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2100 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2101 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2103 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2104 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2105 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2106 the program, not by the shell.
2108 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2109 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2114 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2115 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2116 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2117 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2118 it again without arguments.
2122 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2126 @section Your Program's Environment
2128 @cindex environment (of your program)
2129 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2130 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2131 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2132 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2133 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2134 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2135 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2139 @item path @var{directory}
2140 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2141 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2142 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2143 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2144 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2145 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2146 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2148 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2149 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2150 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2151 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2152 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2153 @var{directory} to the search path.
2154 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2155 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2159 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2160 environment variable).
2162 @kindex show environment
2163 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2164 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2165 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2166 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2167 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2169 @kindex set environment
2170 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2171 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2172 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2173 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2174 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2175 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2177 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2178 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2180 For example, this command:
2187 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2188 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2189 are not actually required.)
2191 @kindex unset environment
2192 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2193 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2194 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2195 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2196 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2199 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2201 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2202 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2203 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2204 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2205 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2206 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2209 @node Working Directory
2210 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2212 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2213 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2214 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2215 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2216 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2217 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2219 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2220 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2225 @cindex change working directory
2226 @item cd @var{directory}
2227 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2231 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2234 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2235 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2236 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2237 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2238 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2239 current working directory of the debuggee.
2242 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2247 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2248 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2249 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2250 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2251 running your program.
2254 @kindex info terminal
2256 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2260 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2261 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2268 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2271 @cindex controlling terminal
2272 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2273 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2274 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2275 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2276 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2283 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2284 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2285 that as their controlling terminal.
2287 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2288 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2291 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2292 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2293 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2294 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2296 @cindex inferior tty
2297 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2298 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2299 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2303 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2304 @kindex set inferior-tty
2305 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2307 @item show inferior-tty
2308 @kindex show inferior-tty
2309 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2313 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2318 @item attach @var{process-id}
2319 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2320 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2321 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2322 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2323 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2325 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2326 executing the command.
2329 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2330 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2331 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2332 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2334 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2335 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2336 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2337 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2338 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2341 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2342 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2343 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2344 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2345 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2346 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2347 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2352 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2353 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2354 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2355 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2356 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2357 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2358 executing the command.
2361 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2362 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2363 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2364 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2365 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2369 @section Killing the Child Process
2374 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2377 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2378 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2381 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2382 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2383 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2384 outside the debugger.
2386 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2387 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2388 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2389 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2390 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2391 breakpoint settings).
2393 @node Inferiors and Programs
2394 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2396 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2397 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2398 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2399 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2400 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2401 from multiple executables.
2404 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2405 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2406 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2407 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2408 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2409 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2410 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2411 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2412 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2413 threads running in it.
2415 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2419 @kindex info inferiors
2420 @item info inferiors
2421 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2423 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2427 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2430 the target system's inferior identifier
2433 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2438 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2439 indicates the current inferior.
2443 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2446 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2447 Num Description Executable
2448 2 process 2307 hello
2449 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2452 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2455 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2456 @item inferior @var{infno}
2457 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2458 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2459 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2463 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2464 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2465 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2466 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2467 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2468 @w{@code{remove-inferior}} command.
2471 @kindex add-inferior
2472 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2473 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2474 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2475 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2476 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2477 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2479 @kindex clone-inferior
2480 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2481 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2482 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2483 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2484 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2487 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2488 Num Description Executable
2489 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2490 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2493 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2494 Num Description Executable
2496 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2499 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2501 @kindex remove-inferior
2502 @item remove-inferior @var{infno}
2503 Removes the inferior @var{infno}. It is not possible to remove an
2504 inferior that is running with this command. For those, use the
2505 @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2509 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2510 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2511 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2512 using the @w{@code{kill inferior}} command:
2515 @kindex detach inferior @var{infno}
2516 @item detach inferior @var{infno}
2517 Detach from the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2518 @var{infno}. Note that the inferior's entry still stays on the list
2519 of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its Description will
2522 @kindex kill inferior @var{infno}
2523 @item kill inferior @var{infno}
2524 Kill the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2525 @var{infno}. Note that the inferior's entry still stays on the list
2526 of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its Description will
2530 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2531 @code{detach inferior}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferior}, or after
2532 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2533 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2536 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2537 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2540 @kindex set print inferior-events
2541 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2542 @item set print inferior-events
2543 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2544 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2545 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2546 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2547 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2548 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2550 @kindex show print inferior-events
2551 @item show print inferior-events
2552 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2553 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2556 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2557 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2558 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2561 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2562 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2563 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2564 info program-spaces}} command.
2567 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2568 @item maint info program-spaces
2569 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2572 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2576 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2579 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2580 the @code{file} command.
2585 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2586 indicates the current program space.
2588 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2589 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2590 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2593 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2596 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2600 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2601 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2602 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2603 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2604 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2607 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2610 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2613 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2614 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2618 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2620 @cindex threads of execution
2621 @cindex multiple threads
2622 @cindex switching threads
2623 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2624 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2625 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2626 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2627 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2628 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2629 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2631 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2635 @item automatic notification of new threads
2636 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2637 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2638 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2639 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2640 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2641 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2642 messages on thread start and exit.
2643 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2644 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2645 isn't compatible with the program.
2649 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2650 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2651 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2652 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2653 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2657 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2658 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2659 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2660 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2662 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2663 @c doesn't support threads"?
2666 @cindex focus of debugging
2667 @cindex current thread
2668 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2669 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2670 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2671 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2672 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2674 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2675 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2676 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2677 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2678 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2679 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2680 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2681 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2682 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2683 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2686 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2690 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2691 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2694 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2695 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2696 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2698 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2699 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2700 @c threads ab initio?
2702 @cindex thread number
2703 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2704 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2705 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2708 @kindex info threads
2710 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2711 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2715 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2718 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2721 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2725 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2726 indicates the current thread.
2730 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2733 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2734 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2735 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2736 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2742 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2743 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2744 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2745 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2746 thread in your program.
2748 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2749 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2750 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2751 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2752 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2753 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2754 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2755 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2756 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2760 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2764 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2767 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2769 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2770 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2773 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2775 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2777 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2781 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2782 indicates the current thread.
2786 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2789 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2790 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2792 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2793 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2794 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2795 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2798 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2799 Solaris-specific command:
2802 @item maint info sol-threads
2803 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2804 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2805 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2809 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2810 @item thread @var{threadno}
2811 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2812 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2813 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2814 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2815 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2818 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2819 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2820 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2821 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2825 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2826 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2829 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2830 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2831 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2832 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2833 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2834 information on convenience variables.
2836 @kindex thread apply
2837 @cindex apply command to several threads
2838 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2839 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2840 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2841 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2842 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2843 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2844 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2845 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2847 @kindex set print thread-events
2848 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2849 @item set print thread-events
2850 @itemx set print thread-events on
2851 @itemx set print thread-events off
2852 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2853 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2854 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2855 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2856 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2858 @kindex show print thread-events
2859 @item show print thread-events
2860 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2861 have started and exited.
2864 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2865 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2866 programs with multiple threads.
2868 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2869 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2872 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2873 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2874 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2875 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2876 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2877 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2880 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2881 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2882 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2883 to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue
2884 with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory
2885 from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process.
2887 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2888 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2889 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2890 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2891 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2892 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2893 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2895 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2896 only on some platforms.
2898 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2899 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2900 Display current libthread_db search path.
2902 @kindex set debug libthread-db
2903 @kindex show debug libthread-db
2904 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
2905 @item set debug libthread-db
2906 @itemx show debug libthread-db
2907 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
2908 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
2912 @section Debugging Forks
2914 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2915 @cindex multiple processes
2916 @cindex processes, multiple
2917 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2918 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2919 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2920 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2921 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2922 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2923 will cause it to terminate.
2925 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2926 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2927 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2928 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2929 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2930 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2931 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2932 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2933 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2934 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2936 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2937 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2938 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2939 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2941 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2942 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2944 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2945 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2948 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2949 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2950 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2951 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2952 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2956 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2957 unimpeded. This is the default.
2960 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2965 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2966 @item show follow-fork-mode
2967 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2970 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2971 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2972 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2975 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2976 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2977 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2978 retain debugger control over them both.
2982 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2983 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2984 independently. This is the default.
2987 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2988 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2989 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2994 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2995 @item show detach-on-fork
2996 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2999 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3000 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3001 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3002 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3003 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3004 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3006 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3007 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferior}} command (allowing it
3008 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferior}}
3009 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3012 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3013 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3014 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3015 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3016 the child process's @code{main}.
3018 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3019 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3021 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3022 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3023 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3024 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3025 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3026 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3030 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3031 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3033 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3034 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3036 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3040 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3041 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3042 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3048 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3050 Id Description Executable
3053 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3054 Program exited normally.
3055 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3056 Id Description Executable
3062 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3063 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3064 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3065 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3066 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3071 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3072 Id Description Executable
3075 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3076 Program exited normally.
3077 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3078 Id Description Executable
3085 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3086 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3087 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3089 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3090 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3095 @cindex snapshot of a process
3096 @cindex rewind program state
3098 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3099 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3100 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3103 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3104 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3105 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3106 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3107 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3109 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3110 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3111 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3112 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3113 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3114 start again from there.
3116 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3117 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3119 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3124 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3125 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3126 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3128 @kindex info checkpoints
3129 @item info checkpoints
3130 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3131 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3138 @item Source line, or label
3141 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3142 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3143 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3144 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3145 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3146 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3147 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3149 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3150 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3151 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3154 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3155 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3156 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3160 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3161 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3162 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3163 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3164 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3165 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3166 previously read data can be read again.
3168 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3169 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3170 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3171 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3172 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3173 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3175 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3176 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3177 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3178 different execution path this time.
3180 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3181 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3182 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3183 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3184 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3185 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3186 potentially pose a problem.
3188 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3190 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3191 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3192 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3193 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3194 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3197 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3198 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3199 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3200 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3201 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3204 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3206 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3207 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3208 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3210 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3211 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3212 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3213 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3214 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3215 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3216 explicitly request this information at any time.
3219 @kindex info program
3221 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3222 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3226 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3227 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3229 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3233 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3236 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3237 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3238 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3239 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3240 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3241 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3244 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3245 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3246 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3247 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3248 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3252 @cindex data breakpoints
3253 @cindex memory tracing
3254 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3255 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3256 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3257 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3258 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3259 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3260 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3261 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3262 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3263 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3266 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3267 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3271 @cindex breakpoint on events
3272 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3273 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3274 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3275 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3276 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3277 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3278 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3280 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3281 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3282 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3283 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3284 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3285 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3286 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3287 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3290 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3291 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3292 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3293 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3294 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3295 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3296 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3299 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3300 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3301 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3302 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3303 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3304 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3305 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3306 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3307 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3308 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3312 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3314 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3315 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3317 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3320 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3321 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3322 @cindex latest breakpoint
3323 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3324 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3325 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3326 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3327 convenience variables.
3330 @item break @var{location}
3331 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3332 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3333 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3334 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3335 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3337 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3338 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3339 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3342 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3343 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3344 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3347 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3348 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3349 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3350 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3351 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3352 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3353 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3354 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3355 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3358 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3359 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3360 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3361 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3362 existed when your program stopped.
3364 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3365 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3366 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3367 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3368 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3369 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3370 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3373 @item tbreak @var{args}
3374 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3375 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3376 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3377 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3380 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3381 @item hbreak @var{args}
3382 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3383 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3384 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3385 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3386 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3387 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3388 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3389 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3390 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3391 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3392 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3393 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3394 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3395 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3396 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3397 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3398 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3399 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3402 @item thbreak @var{args}
3403 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3404 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3405 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3406 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3407 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3408 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3409 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3410 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3413 @cindex regular expression
3414 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3415 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3416 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3417 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3418 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3419 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3420 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3421 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3422 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3424 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3425 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3426 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3427 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3428 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3429 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3431 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3432 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3433 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3436 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3437 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3438 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3441 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3444 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3445 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3446 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3447 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3448 every function in a given file:
3451 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3454 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3455 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3457 @kindex info breakpoints
3458 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3459 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3460 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3461 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3462 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3463 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3464 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3467 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3469 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3471 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3472 @item Enabled or Disabled
3473 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3474 that are not enabled.
3476 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3477 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3478 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3479 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3480 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3481 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3483 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3484 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3485 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3486 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3490 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3491 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3492 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3493 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3494 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3498 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3499 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3500 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3501 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3502 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3505 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3506 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3507 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3508 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3509 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3510 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3513 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3514 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3515 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3516 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3518 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3519 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3520 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3521 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3525 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3526 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3529 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3530 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3533 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3534 several places where that function is inlined.
3537 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3538 the relevant locations@footnote{
3539 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3540 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3541 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3542 info with line numbers for them.}.
3544 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3545 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3546 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3547 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3548 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3549 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3550 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3555 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3556 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3558 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3559 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3560 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3563 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3564 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3565 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3566 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3567 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3568 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3569 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3570 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3571 that belong to that breakpoint.
3573 @cindex pending breakpoints
3574 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3575 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3576 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3577 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3578 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3579 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3580 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3581 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3582 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3583 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3584 is not yet resolved.
3586 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3587 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3588 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3589 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3590 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3591 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3593 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3594 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3595 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3596 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3598 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3599 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3600 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3602 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3603 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3604 address specification to an address:
3606 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3607 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3609 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3610 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3611 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3613 @item set breakpoint pending on
3614 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3615 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3617 @item set breakpoint pending off
3618 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3619 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3620 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3622 @item show breakpoint pending
3623 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3626 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3627 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3628 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3630 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3631 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3632 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3633 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3634 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3635 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3636 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3639 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3641 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3642 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3644 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3645 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3646 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3647 breakpoint must be used.
3649 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3650 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3651 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3652 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3655 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3656 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3657 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3658 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3659 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3660 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3661 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3662 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3663 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3665 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3666 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3668 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3669 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3670 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3671 removed from the target when it stops.
3673 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3674 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3675 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3676 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3677 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3679 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3680 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3681 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3682 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3683 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3684 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3685 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3688 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3689 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3690 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3691 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3692 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3693 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3694 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3695 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3698 @node Set Watchpoints
3699 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3701 @cindex setting watchpoints
3702 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3703 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3704 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3705 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3706 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3710 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3713 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3714 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3715 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3718 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3719 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3720 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3723 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3724 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3725 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3726 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3727 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3728 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3729 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3730 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3731 the expression changes.
3733 @cindex software watchpoints
3734 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3735 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3736 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3737 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3738 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3739 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3742 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3743 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3744 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3748 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3749 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3750 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3751 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3752 to watch the value of a single variable:
3755 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3758 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3759 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3760 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3761 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3762 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3763 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3765 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3766 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3767 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3768 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3769 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3770 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3771 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3775 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3776 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3780 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3781 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3782 or written into by the program.
3784 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3785 @item info watchpoints
3786 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3787 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3790 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3791 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3792 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3793 a never-changing value:
3796 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3797 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3798 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3799 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3802 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3803 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3804 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3805 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3806 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3807 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3809 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3810 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3811 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3812 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3813 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3814 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3815 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3816 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3819 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3820 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3821 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3823 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3824 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3825 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3828 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3829 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3830 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3832 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3835 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3839 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3841 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3842 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3843 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3844 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3845 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3846 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3847 will print a message like this:
3850 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3853 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3854 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3855 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3856 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3857 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3858 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3859 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3860 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3862 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3863 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3864 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3865 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3866 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3867 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3870 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3874 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3876 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3877 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3878 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3879 expression with separately allocated resources.
3881 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3882 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3883 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3885 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3886 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3887 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3888 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3889 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3890 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3891 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3892 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3893 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3895 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3896 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3897 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3898 watched expression from every thread.
3901 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3902 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3903 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3904 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3905 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3906 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3907 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3908 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3909 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3912 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3914 @node Set Catchpoints
3915 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3916 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3917 @cindex exception handlers
3918 @cindex event handling
3920 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3921 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3922 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3926 @item catch @var{event}
3927 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3930 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3931 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3934 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3937 @cindex Ada exception catching
3938 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3939 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3940 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3941 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3942 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3944 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3945 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3946 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3947 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3948 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3949 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3950 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3951 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3953 @item exception unhandled
3954 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3957 A failed Ada assertion.
3960 @cindex break on fork/exec
3961 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3965 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
3966 @cindex break on a system call.
3967 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
3968 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
3969 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
3970 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
3971 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
3972 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
3975 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
3976 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
3977 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
3978 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
3980 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
3981 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
3982 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
3983 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
3985 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
3986 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
3987 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
3990 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
3991 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
3992 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
3993 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
3994 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
3995 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
3996 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
3997 behind the OS upgrades).
3999 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4003 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4004 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4006 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4008 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4009 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4013 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4014 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4018 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4021 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4022 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4024 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4026 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4027 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4031 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4032 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4036 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4037 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4038 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4041 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4042 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4044 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4046 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4047 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4051 Program exited normally.
4055 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4056 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4057 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4058 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4061 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4062 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4063 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4067 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4068 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4069 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4070 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4071 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4072 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4075 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4076 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4077 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4078 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4079 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4083 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4085 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4086 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4089 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4090 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4093 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4096 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4100 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4105 @item tcatch @var{event}
4106 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4107 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4111 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4113 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4114 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4118 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4119 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4120 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4121 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4122 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4123 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4124 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4125 disabled within interactive calls.
4128 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4131 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4134 @cindex raise exceptions
4135 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4136 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4137 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4138 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4139 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4140 out where the exception was raised.
4142 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4143 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4144 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4145 which has the following ANSI C interface:
4148 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4149 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4150 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4154 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4155 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4156 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4158 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4159 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4160 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4161 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4166 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4168 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4169 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4170 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4171 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4172 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4173 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4175 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4176 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4177 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4178 their breakpoint numbers.
4180 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4181 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4182 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4187 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4188 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4189 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4190 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4192 @item clear @var{location}
4193 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4194 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4195 most useful ones are listed below:
4198 @item clear @var{function}
4199 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4200 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4202 @item clear @var{linenum}
4203 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4204 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4205 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4208 @cindex delete breakpoints
4210 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4211 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4212 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4213 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4214 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4215 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4219 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4221 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4222 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4223 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4224 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4225 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4227 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4228 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4229 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4230 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4231 do not know which numbers to use.
4233 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4234 affects all of its locations.
4236 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
4237 states of enablement:
4241 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4242 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4244 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4246 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4249 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4250 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4251 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4254 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4255 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4259 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4260 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4261 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4262 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4263 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4264 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4265 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4268 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4269 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4270 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4272 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4273 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4274 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4276 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4277 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4278 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4279 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4282 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4283 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4284 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4285 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4286 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4287 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4288 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4289 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4293 @subsection Break Conditions
4294 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4295 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4297 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4298 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4299 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4300 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4301 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4302 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4303 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4304 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4306 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4307 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4308 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4309 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4310 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4312 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4313 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4314 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4315 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4318 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4319 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4320 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4321 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4322 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4323 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4324 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4325 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4327 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4328 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4330 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4331 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4332 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4333 with the @code{condition} command.
4335 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4336 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4337 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4342 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4343 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4344 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4345 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4346 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4347 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4348 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4349 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4350 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4351 prints an error message:
4354 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4359 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4360 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4361 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4363 @item condition @var{bnum}
4364 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4365 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4368 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4369 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4370 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4371 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4372 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4373 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4374 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4375 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4376 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4377 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4378 your program reaches it.
4382 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4383 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4384 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4385 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4388 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4391 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4392 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4393 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4394 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4396 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4397 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4398 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4400 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4401 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4402 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4406 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4409 @node Break Commands
4410 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4412 @cindex breakpoint commands
4413 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4414 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4415 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4416 enable other breakpoints.
4420 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4421 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4422 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4424 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4425 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4426 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4428 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4429 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4431 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4432 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4433 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4434 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4435 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4436 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4437 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4441 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4442 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4444 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4445 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4446 that resumes execution.
4448 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4449 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4450 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4451 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4452 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4455 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4456 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4457 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4458 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4459 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4460 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4462 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4463 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4464 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4466 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4467 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4473 printf "x is %d\n",x
4478 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4479 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4480 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4481 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4482 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4483 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4484 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4495 @node Save Breakpoints
4496 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4498 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4499 breakpoints}} command.
4502 @kindex save breakpoints
4503 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4504 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4505 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4506 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4507 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4508 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4509 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4510 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4511 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4512 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4513 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4514 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4515 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4516 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4517 that can no longer be recreated.
4520 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4521 @node Error in Breakpoints
4522 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4524 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4525 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4527 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4528 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4530 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4531 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4535 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4536 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4537 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4539 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4540 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4542 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4543 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4544 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4546 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4547 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4548 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4549 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4551 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4552 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4553 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4554 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4555 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4556 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4557 first in the bundle.
4559 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4560 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4561 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4562 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4563 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4564 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4567 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4568 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4571 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4574 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4575 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4576 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4577 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4578 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4579 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4580 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4581 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4583 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4584 adjusted breakpoints:
4587 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4591 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4592 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4593 frequently than expected.
4595 @node Continuing and Stepping
4596 @section Continuing and Stepping
4600 @cindex resuming execution
4601 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4602 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4603 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4604 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4605 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4606 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4607 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4608 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4612 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4613 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4614 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4615 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4616 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4617 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4618 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4619 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4620 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4621 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4623 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4624 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4625 @code{continue} is ignored.
4627 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4628 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4629 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4633 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4634 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4635 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4636 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4638 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4639 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4640 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4641 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4642 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4643 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4647 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4649 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4650 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4651 abbreviated @code{s}.
4654 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4655 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4656 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4657 @c distinction here.
4658 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4659 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4660 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4661 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4662 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4663 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4667 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4668 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4669 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4670 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4671 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4672 called within the line.
4674 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4675 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4676 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4677 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4678 was any debugging information about the routine.
4680 @item step @var{count}
4681 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4682 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4683 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4686 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4687 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4688 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4689 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4690 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4691 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4692 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4693 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4695 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4698 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4699 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4701 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4702 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4703 @c function are executed without stopping.
4705 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4706 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4707 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4709 @kindex set step-mode
4711 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4712 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4713 @itemx set step-mode on
4714 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4715 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4716 information rather than stepping over it.
4718 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4719 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4720 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4722 @item set step-mode off
4723 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4724 debug information. This is the default.
4726 @item show step-mode
4727 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4728 source line debug information.
4731 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4733 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4734 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4735 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4737 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4738 ,Returning from a Function}).
4741 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4742 @cindex run until specified location
4745 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4746 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4747 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4748 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4749 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4750 than the address of the jump.
4752 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4753 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4754 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4755 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4756 through the next iteration.
4758 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4761 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4762 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4763 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4764 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4765 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4769 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4771 (@value{GDBP}) until
4772 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4775 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4776 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4777 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4778 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4779 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4780 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4781 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4783 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4784 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4787 @item until @var{location}
4788 @itemx u @var{location}
4789 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4790 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4791 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4792 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4793 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4794 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4795 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4796 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4797 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4798 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4799 invocations have returned.
4802 94 int factorial (int value)
4804 96 if (value > 1) @{
4805 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4812 @kindex advance @var{location}
4813 @itemx advance @var{location}
4814 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4815 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4816 @ref{Specify Location}.
4817 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4818 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4819 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4820 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4824 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4826 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4828 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4830 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4831 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4832 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4833 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4835 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4839 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4841 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4843 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4844 proceed until the function returns.
4846 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4853 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4854 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4855 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4856 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4857 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4858 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4859 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4860 requested an alarm).
4862 @cindex fatal signals
4863 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4864 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4865 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4866 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4867 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4868 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4870 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4871 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4874 @cindex handling signals
4875 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4876 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4877 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4878 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4879 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4882 @kindex info signals
4886 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4887 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4888 the defined types of signals.
4890 @item info signals @var{sig}
4891 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4893 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4896 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4897 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4898 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4899 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4900 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4901 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4902 say what change to make.
4906 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4907 Their full names are:
4911 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4912 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4915 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4916 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4919 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4922 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4923 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4927 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4928 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4929 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4933 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4934 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4938 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4940 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4941 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4942 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4943 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4944 program sees that signal when you continue.
4946 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4947 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4948 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4951 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4952 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4953 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4954 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4955 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4956 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4957 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4958 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4961 @cindex extra signal information
4962 @anchor{extra signal information}
4964 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4965 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4966 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4967 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4968 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4969 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4970 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4971 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4972 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4975 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4976 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4980 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4981 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4982 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4984 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4991 struct @{...@} _kill;
4992 struct @{...@} _timer;
4994 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4995 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4996 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4999 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5003 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5004 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5008 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5011 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5013 @cindex stopped threads
5014 @cindex threads, stopped
5016 @cindex continuing threads
5017 @cindex threads, continuing
5019 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5020 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5021 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5022 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5023 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5024 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5025 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5026 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5027 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5030 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5031 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5032 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5033 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5034 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5035 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5039 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5041 @cindex all-stop mode
5043 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5044 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5045 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5046 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5049 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5050 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5051 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5053 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5054 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5055 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5056 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5057 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5058 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5061 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5062 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5063 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5064 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5066 @cindex automatic thread selection
5067 @cindex switching threads automatically
5068 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5069 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5070 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5071 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5072 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5075 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5076 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5079 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5080 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5081 @cindex lock scheduler
5082 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5083 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5084 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5085 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5086 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5087 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5088 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5089 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5090 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5091 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5092 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5093 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5095 @item show scheduler-locking
5096 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5099 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5100 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5101 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5102 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5103 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5104 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5105 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5106 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5107 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5108 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5109 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5110 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5111 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5112 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5115 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5116 @item set schedule-multiple
5117 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5118 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5119 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5120 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5121 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5122 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5124 @item show schedule-multiple
5125 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5130 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5132 @cindex non-stop mode
5134 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5135 @c with more details.
5137 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5138 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5139 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5140 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5141 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5142 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5144 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5145 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5146 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5147 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5148 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5149 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5150 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5151 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5152 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5153 independently and simultaneously.
5155 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5156 or attach to your program:
5159 # Enable the async interface.
5162 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5165 # Finally, turn it on!
5169 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5172 @kindex set non-stop
5173 @item set non-stop on
5174 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5175 @item set non-stop off
5176 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5177 @kindex show non-stop
5179 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5182 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5183 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5184 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5185 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5186 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5187 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5188 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5191 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5192 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5193 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5195 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5196 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5197 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5198 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5199 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5201 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5202 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5203 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5204 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5205 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5207 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5209 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5210 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5211 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5212 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5213 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5214 previously current thread.
5216 @node Background Execution
5217 @subsection Background Execution
5219 @cindex foreground execution
5220 @cindex background execution
5221 @cindex asynchronous execution
5222 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5224 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5225 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5226 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5227 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5228 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5229 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5231 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5232 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5233 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5236 @kindex set target-async
5237 @item set target-async on
5238 Enable asynchronous mode.
5239 @item set target-async off
5240 Disable asynchronous mode.
5241 @kindex show target-async
5242 @item show target-async
5243 Show the current target-async setting.
5246 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5247 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5249 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5250 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5251 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5257 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5261 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5265 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5269 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5273 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5277 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5281 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5285 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5289 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5293 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5294 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5295 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5296 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5297 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5298 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5300 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5301 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5308 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5309 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5310 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5311 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5314 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5315 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5317 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5318 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5319 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5322 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5323 @cindex thread breakpoints
5324 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5325 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5326 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5327 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5328 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5329 specify some source line.
5331 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5332 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5333 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5334 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5335 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5337 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5338 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5341 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5342 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5343 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5346 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5351 @node Interrupted System Calls
5352 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5354 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5355 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5356 @cindex premature return from system calls
5357 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5358 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5359 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5360 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5361 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5362 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5365 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5366 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5369 For example, do not write code like this:
5375 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5376 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5378 Instead, write this:
5383 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5386 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5387 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5388 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5391 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5392 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5393 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5394 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5397 @subsection Observer Mode
5399 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5400 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5401 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5402 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5403 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5405 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5406 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5407 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5410 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5411 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5412 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
5413 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
5414 stream will still not be able to be placed.
5419 @item set observer on
5420 @itemx set observer off
5421 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
5422 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
5423 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
5424 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
5427 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
5429 @kindex may-write-registers
5430 @item set may-write-registers on
5431 @itemx set may-write-registers off
5432 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
5433 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
5434 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
5436 @item show may-write-registers
5437 Show the current permission to write registers.
5439 @kindex may-write-memory
5440 @item set may-write-memory on
5441 @itemx set may-write-memory off
5442 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
5443 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
5444 defaults to @code{on}.
5446 @item show may-write-memory
5447 Show the current permission to write memory.
5449 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
5450 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
5451 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
5452 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
5453 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
5454 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5456 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
5457 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
5459 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
5460 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
5461 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
5462 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
5463 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5464 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
5465 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5467 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
5468 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
5470 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5471 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
5472 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
5473 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
5474 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5475 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
5476 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5478 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5479 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
5481 @kindex may-interrupt
5482 @item set may-interrupt on
5483 @itemx set may-interrupt off
5484 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
5485 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
5486 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
5487 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5489 @item show may-interrupt
5490 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
5494 @node Reverse Execution
5495 @chapter Running programs backward
5496 @cindex reverse execution
5497 @cindex running programs backward
5499 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5500 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5501 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5502 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5504 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5505 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5506 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5507 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5508 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5509 all target environments can support reverse execution.
5511 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5512 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5513 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5514 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5515 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5516 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5517 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5518 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5519 prior values@footnote{
5520 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5521 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5522 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5524 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5525 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5526 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5527 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5528 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5529 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5530 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5533 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5534 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5537 @kindex reverse-continue
5538 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5539 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5540 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5541 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5542 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5543 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5544 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5546 @kindex reverse-step
5547 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5548 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5549 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5550 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5552 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5553 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5554 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5555 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5556 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5557 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5559 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5560 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5562 @kindex reverse-stepi
5563 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5564 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5565 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5566 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5567 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5568 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5569 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5571 @kindex reverse-next
5572 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5573 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5574 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5575 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5576 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5577 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5578 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5579 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5580 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5581 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5583 @kindex reverse-nexti
5584 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5585 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5586 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5587 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5588 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5589 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5590 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5593 @kindex reverse-finish
5594 @item reverse-finish
5595 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5596 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5597 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5598 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5600 @kindex set exec-direction
5601 @item set exec-direction
5602 Set the direction of target execution.
5603 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5604 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5605 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5606 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5607 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5608 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5609 @item set exec-direction forward
5610 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5611 This is the default.
5615 @node Process Record and Replay
5616 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5617 @cindex process record and replay
5618 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5620 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5621 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5622 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5625 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5626 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5627 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5628 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5629 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5630 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5631 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5632 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5636 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5637 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5638 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5641 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5642 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5643 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5644 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5645 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5646 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5648 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5649 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5650 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5651 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5653 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5654 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5657 @kindex target record
5661 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5662 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5663 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5664 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5665 the @kbd{target record} command.
5667 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5669 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5670 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5671 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5672 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5673 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5675 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5676 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5677 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5678 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5679 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5680 support these two modes.
5685 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5686 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5687 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5689 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5690 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5691 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5692 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5693 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5695 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5696 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5697 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5698 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5699 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5701 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5702 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5705 @item record save @var{filename}
5706 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5707 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
5708 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
5710 @kindex record restore
5711 @item record restore @var{filename}
5712 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5713 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
5715 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5716 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5717 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5719 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5720 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5721 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5722 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5723 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5724 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5725 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5726 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5728 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5729 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5730 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5732 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5733 @item show record insn-number-max
5734 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5736 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5737 @item set record stop-at-limit
5738 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5739 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5740 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5741 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5742 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5743 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5745 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5746 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5748 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5749 @item show record stop-at-limit
5750 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5752 @kindex set record memory-query
5753 @item set record memory-query
5754 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
5755 changes caused by an instruction. If ON, @value{GDBN} will query
5756 whether to stop the inferior in that case.
5758 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
5759 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
5760 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
5761 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
5764 @kindex show record memory-query
5765 @item show record memory-query
5766 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
5770 Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
5771 in-memory execution log buffer, including:
5775 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
5777 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
5779 Highest recorded instruction number.
5781 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
5783 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
5785 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
5788 @kindex record delete
5791 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5792 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5793 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5794 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5799 @chapter Examining the Stack
5801 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5802 stopped and how it got there.
5805 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5807 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5808 the arguments of the call,
5809 and the local variables of the function being called.
5810 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5811 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5814 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5815 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5817 @cindex selected frame
5818 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5819 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5820 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5821 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5822 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5823 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5825 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5826 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5827 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5830 * Frames:: Stack frames
5831 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5832 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5833 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5838 @section Stack Frames
5840 @cindex frame, definition
5842 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5843 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5844 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5845 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5846 which the function is executing.
5848 @cindex initial frame
5849 @cindex outermost frame
5850 @cindex innermost frame
5851 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5852 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5853 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5854 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5855 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5856 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5857 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5858 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5860 @cindex frame pointer
5861 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5862 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5863 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5864 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5865 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5866 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5868 @cindex frame number
5869 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5870 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5871 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5872 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5873 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5875 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5876 @c underflow problems.
5877 @cindex frameless execution
5878 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5879 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5881 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5883 generates functions without a frame.)
5884 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5885 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5886 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5887 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5888 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5889 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5890 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5893 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5894 @cindex current stack frame
5895 @item frame @var{args}
5896 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5897 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5898 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5899 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5901 @kindex select-frame
5902 @cindex selecting frame silently
5904 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5905 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5913 @cindex call stack traces
5914 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5915 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5916 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5921 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5924 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5925 frames in the stack.
5927 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5928 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5930 @item backtrace @var{n}
5932 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5934 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5936 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5938 @item backtrace full
5940 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5941 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5942 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5943 number of frames to print, as described above.
5948 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5949 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5951 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5952 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5953 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5954 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5955 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5956 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5957 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5958 multi-threaded program.
5960 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5961 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5962 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5963 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5964 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5967 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5968 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5972 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5974 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5975 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5977 (More stack frames follow...)
5982 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5983 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5984 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5987 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5988 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5989 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5990 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5991 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5993 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5994 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5995 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5996 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5997 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5998 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5999 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6000 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6001 such a backtrace might look like:
6005 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6007 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6008 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6010 (More stack frames follow...)
6015 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6016 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
6018 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6019 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6020 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6022 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6023 @cindex program entry point
6024 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6025 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6026 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6027 @code{main}@footnote{
6028 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6029 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6030 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6031 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6032 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6033 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6035 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6036 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6039 @item set backtrace past-main
6040 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6041 @kindex set backtrace
6042 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6044 @item set backtrace past-main off
6045 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6048 @item show backtrace past-main
6049 @kindex show backtrace
6050 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6052 @item set backtrace past-entry
6053 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6054 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6055 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6056 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6058 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6059 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6060 application. This is the default.
6062 @item show backtrace past-entry
6063 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6065 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6066 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6067 @cindex backtrace limit
6068 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
6071 @item show backtrace limit
6072 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6076 @section Selecting a Frame
6078 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
6079 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
6080 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
6081 of the stack frame just selected.
6084 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
6085 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
6088 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
6089 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
6090 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
6093 @item frame @var{addr}
6095 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
6096 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
6097 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
6098 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
6099 switches between them.
6101 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
6102 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
6104 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
6105 pointer and a program counter.
6107 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
6108 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
6112 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6113 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
6114 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
6117 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
6119 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6120 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
6121 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
6122 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
6125 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
6126 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
6127 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
6128 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
6136 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
6138 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
6142 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
6143 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
6144 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
6145 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
6146 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
6150 @kindex down-silently
6152 @item up-silently @var{n}
6153 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
6154 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
6155 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
6156 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
6157 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
6162 @section Information About a Frame
6164 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
6170 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
6171 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
6172 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
6173 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
6174 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6177 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
6180 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
6185 the address of the frame
6187 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
6189 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
6191 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
6193 the address of the frame's arguments
6195 the address of the frame's local variables
6197 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
6199 which registers were saved in the frame
6202 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
6203 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
6204 the usual conventions.
6206 @item info frame @var{addr}
6207 @itemx info f @var{addr}
6208 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
6209 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
6210 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
6211 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
6212 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6216 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
6220 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
6221 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
6222 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
6225 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
6226 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
6228 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
6229 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
6230 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
6231 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
6232 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
6238 @chapter Examining Source Files
6240 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
6241 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
6242 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
6243 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
6244 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
6245 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
6246 source files by explicit command.
6248 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6249 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6250 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6253 * List:: Printing source lines
6254 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6255 * Edit:: Editing source files
6256 * Search:: Searching source files
6257 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6258 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6262 @section Printing Source Lines
6265 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6266 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6267 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6268 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6269 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6271 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6274 @item list @var{linenum}
6275 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6276 current source file.
6278 @item list @var{function}
6279 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6283 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6284 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6285 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6286 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6287 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6290 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6293 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6294 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6295 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6298 @kindex set listsize
6299 @item set listsize @var{count}
6300 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6301 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6303 @kindex show listsize
6305 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6308 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6309 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6310 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6311 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6312 each repetition moves up in the source file.
6314 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6315 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6316 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6317 to specify some source line.
6319 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6322 @item list @var{linespec}
6323 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6325 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
6326 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6327 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6328 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6329 the same source file as the first linespec.
6331 @item list ,@var{last}
6332 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6334 @item list @var{first},
6335 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6338 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6341 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6344 As described in the preceding table.
6347 @node Specify Location
6348 @section Specifying a Location
6349 @cindex specifying location
6352 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6353 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6354 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6355 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6357 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6358 @value{GDBN} understands:
6362 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6365 @itemx +@var{offset}
6366 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6367 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6368 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6369 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6370 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6371 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6372 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6375 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6376 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6378 @item @var{function}
6379 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6380 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6382 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6383 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6384 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6385 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6386 functions in different source files.
6389 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
6390 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
6391 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
6392 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
6393 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
6395 @item *@var{address}
6396 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6397 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6398 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6399 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6400 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6403 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6404 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6405 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6406 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6407 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6411 @item @var{expression}
6412 Any expression valid in the current working language.
6414 @item @var{funcaddr}
6415 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6416 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6417 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6418 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6419 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6420 (although the Pascal form also works).
6422 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6423 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6425 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6426 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6427 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6428 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6429 functions with identical names in different source files.
6436 @section Editing Source Files
6437 @cindex editing source files
6440 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6441 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6442 The editing program of your choice
6443 is invoked with the current line set to
6444 the active line in the program.
6445 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6446 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6449 @item edit @var{location}
6450 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6451 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6452 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6453 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6454 command most commonly used:
6457 @item edit @var{number}
6458 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6460 @item edit @var{function}
6461 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6466 @subsection Choosing your Editor
6467 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6469 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6470 following command-line syntax:
6472 ex +@var{number} file
6474 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6475 the file where to start editing.}.
6476 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6477 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6478 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6479 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6485 or in the @code{csh} shell,
6487 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6492 @section Searching Source Files
6493 @cindex searching source files
6495 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6500 @kindex forward-search
6501 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
6502 @itemx search @var{regexp}
6503 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6504 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6505 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6506 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6509 @kindex reverse-search
6510 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6511 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6512 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6513 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6514 this command as @code{rev}.
6518 @section Specifying Source Directories
6521 @cindex directories for source files
6522 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6523 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6524 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6525 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6526 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6527 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6528 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6530 For example, suppose an executable references the file
6531 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6532 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6533 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6534 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6535 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6536 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6537 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6538 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6539 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6540 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6542 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
6543 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
6544 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
6545 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
6546 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
6547 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
6549 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
6552 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
6553 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
6554 each line is in the file.
6558 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
6559 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
6560 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
6562 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
6563 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
6565 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
6566 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
6567 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
6568 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
6569 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
6570 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
6571 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
6572 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
6573 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
6574 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
6575 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
6576 name to look up the sources.
6578 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
6579 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
6580 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
6581 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
6582 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
6583 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
6584 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6585 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6587 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6588 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6589 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6590 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6591 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6592 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6593 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6595 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6596 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6597 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6598 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6599 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6600 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6601 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6604 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6605 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6606 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6607 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6608 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6609 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6610 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6612 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6613 @cindex default source path substitution
6614 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6615 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6616 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6617 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6618 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6619 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6620 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6621 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6622 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6626 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6627 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6628 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6629 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6630 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6631 part of absolute file names) or
6632 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6633 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6637 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6638 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6639 @cindex compilation directory
6640 @cindex current directory
6641 @cindex working directory
6642 @cindex directory, current
6643 @cindex directory, compilation
6644 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6645 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6646 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6647 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6648 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6649 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6652 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6654 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6655 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6657 @item set directories @var{path-list}
6658 @kindex set directories
6659 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
6660 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
6662 @item show directories
6663 @kindex show directories
6664 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6666 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6667 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6668 @kindex set substitute-path
6669 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6670 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6671 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6673 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6674 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6677 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6681 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6682 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6683 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6685 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6686 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6687 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6690 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6693 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6694 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6698 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6699 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6700 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6701 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6704 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6705 @kindex unset substitute-path
6706 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6707 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6708 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6710 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6712 @item show substitute-path [path]
6713 @kindex show substitute-path
6714 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6715 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6717 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6722 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6723 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6724 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6728 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6731 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6732 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6733 directories in one command.
6737 @section Source and Machine Code
6738 @cindex source line and its code address
6740 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6741 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6742 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6743 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6744 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6745 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6746 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6751 @item info line @var{linespec}
6752 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6753 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6754 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6757 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6758 the object code for the first line of function
6759 @code{m4_changequote}:
6761 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6762 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6764 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6765 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6769 @cindex code address and its source line
6770 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6771 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6773 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6774 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6777 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6778 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6779 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6780 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6781 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6782 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6783 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6784 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6789 @cindex assembly instructions
6790 @cindex instructions, assembly
6791 @cindex machine instructions
6792 @cindex listing machine instructions
6794 @itemx disassemble /m
6795 @itemx disassemble /r
6796 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6797 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6798 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6799 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6800 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6801 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6802 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6803 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
6804 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
6805 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
6808 @item @var{start},@var{end}
6809 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
6810 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
6811 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
6812 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
6816 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
6817 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
6819 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
6820 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
6822 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
6823 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
6826 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6827 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6830 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
6831 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6832 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6833 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6834 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6835 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6836 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6837 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6838 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6839 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6840 End of assembler dump.
6843 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
6844 program is stopped just after function prologue:
6847 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6848 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6850 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
6851 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6852 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6853 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6854 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6856 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6857 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6858 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6862 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6863 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
6864 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
6866 End of assembler dump.
6869 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
6872 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
6873 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
6874 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
6875 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
6876 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
6877 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
6878 End of assembler dump.
6881 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6882 mnemonics or other syntax.
6884 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6885 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6886 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6887 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6888 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6891 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6892 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6893 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6894 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6895 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6896 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6898 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6899 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6900 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6901 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6903 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6904 @item show disassembly-flavor
6905 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6909 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6910 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6911 @item set disassemble-next-line
6912 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6913 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6914 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6915 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6916 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6917 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6918 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6919 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6920 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6921 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6922 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6923 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6924 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6925 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6926 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6932 @chapter Examining Data
6934 @cindex printing data
6935 @cindex examining data
6938 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6939 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6940 @c different window or something like that.
6941 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6942 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6943 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6944 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6945 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
6946 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
6949 @item print @var{expr}
6950 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6951 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6952 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6953 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6954 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6958 @itemx print /@var{f}
6959 @cindex reprint the last value
6960 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6961 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6962 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6965 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6966 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6967 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6969 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6970 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6971 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6975 * Expressions:: Expressions
6976 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6977 * Variables:: Program variables
6978 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6979 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6980 * Memory:: Examining memory
6981 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6982 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6983 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
6984 * Value History:: Value history
6985 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6986 * Registers:: Registers
6987 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6988 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6989 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6990 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6991 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6992 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6993 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6994 character set than GDB does
6995 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6996 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
7000 @section Expressions
7003 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
7004 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
7005 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
7006 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
7007 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
7008 you compiled your program to include this information; see
7011 @cindex arrays in expressions
7012 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
7013 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
7014 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
7015 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
7016 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
7017 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
7019 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
7020 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
7021 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
7024 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
7025 expressions regardless of your programming language.
7027 @cindex casts, in expressions
7028 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
7029 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
7030 at that address in memory.
7031 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
7033 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
7034 to programming languages:
7038 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
7039 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
7042 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
7043 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
7045 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
7046 @cindex type casting memory
7047 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
7048 @cindex casts, to view memory
7049 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
7050 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
7051 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
7052 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
7053 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
7054 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
7057 @node Ambiguous Expressions
7058 @section Ambiguous Expressions
7059 @cindex ambiguous expressions
7061 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
7062 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
7063 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
7064 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
7065 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
7066 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
7067 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
7069 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
7070 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
7071 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
7072 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
7073 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
7076 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
7077 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
7078 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
7079 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
7080 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
7081 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
7082 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
7085 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
7086 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
7087 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
7089 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
7092 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
7095 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
7096 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
7097 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
7098 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
7099 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
7100 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
7102 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
7103 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
7104 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
7105 Multiple breakpoints were set.
7106 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
7113 @kindex set multiple-symbols
7114 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
7115 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
7117 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
7120 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
7121 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
7122 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
7123 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
7124 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
7125 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
7126 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
7127 in the use of the menu.
7129 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
7130 when an ambiguity is detected.
7132 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
7133 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
7135 @kindex show multiple-symbols
7136 @item show multiple-symbols
7137 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
7141 @section Program Variables
7143 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
7146 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
7147 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
7151 global (or file-static)
7158 visible according to the scope rules of the
7159 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
7162 @noindent This means that in the function
7177 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
7178 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
7179 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
7180 the block where @code{b} is declared.
7182 @cindex variable name conflict
7183 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
7184 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
7185 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
7186 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
7187 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
7188 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
7189 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
7191 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
7193 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
7194 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
7197 @var{file}::@var{variable}
7198 @var{function}::@var{variable}
7202 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
7203 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
7204 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
7205 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
7208 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
7211 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
7212 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
7213 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
7214 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
7215 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
7218 @cindex wrong values
7219 @cindex variable values, wrong
7220 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
7221 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
7223 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
7224 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
7225 scope, and just before exit.
7227 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
7228 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
7229 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
7230 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
7231 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
7232 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
7233 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
7234 variable definitions may be gone.
7236 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
7237 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
7240 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
7241 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
7242 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
7243 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
7244 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
7245 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
7246 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
7249 No symbol "foo" in current context.
7252 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
7253 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
7254 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
7255 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
7256 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
7257 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
7258 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
7259 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
7260 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
7261 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
7262 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
7264 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
7265 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
7266 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
7267 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
7269 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
7270 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
7271 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
7272 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
7273 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
7278 signed char var1[] = "A";
7281 You get during debugging
7286 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
7290 @section Artificial Arrays
7292 @cindex artificial array
7294 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7295 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7296 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7297 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7300 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7301 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7302 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7303 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7304 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7305 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7306 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7307 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7308 example. If a program says
7311 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7315 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7321 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7322 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7323 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7324 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7325 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7327 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7328 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7329 The value need not be in memory:
7331 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7332 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7335 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7336 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7337 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7339 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7340 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7343 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
7344 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
7345 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
7346 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
7347 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7348 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
7349 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
7350 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
7351 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
7352 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
7362 @node Output Formats
7363 @section Output Formats
7365 @cindex formatted output
7366 @cindex output formats
7367 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
7368 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
7369 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
7370 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
7371 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
7373 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
7374 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
7375 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
7376 letters supported are:
7380 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
7384 Print as integer in signed decimal.
7387 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
7390 Print as integer in octal.
7393 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
7394 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
7395 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
7396 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
7399 @cindex unknown address, locating
7400 @cindex locate address
7401 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
7402 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
7403 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
7406 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
7407 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
7411 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
7412 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
7415 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
7416 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
7417 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
7418 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
7420 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
7421 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
7422 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
7426 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
7427 using typical floating point syntax.
7430 @cindex printing strings
7431 @cindex printing byte arrays
7432 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
7433 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
7434 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
7437 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
7438 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
7439 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
7443 @cindex raw printing
7444 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
7445 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
7446 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
7447 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
7448 pretty-printer which might exist.
7451 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
7458 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
7459 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
7461 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
7462 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
7463 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
7466 @section Examining Memory
7468 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
7469 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
7471 @cindex examining memory
7473 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
7474 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
7477 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
7480 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
7481 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
7482 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
7483 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
7484 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
7487 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
7488 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
7489 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
7490 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
7493 @item @var{f}, the display format
7494 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
7495 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
7496 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
7497 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
7498 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
7500 @item @var{u}, the unit size
7501 The unit size is any of
7507 Halfwords (two bytes).
7509 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
7511 Giant words (eight bytes).
7514 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
7515 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
7516 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
7517 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
7518 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
7519 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
7520 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
7521 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
7522 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
7523 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
7526 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
7527 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
7528 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
7529 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
7530 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
7531 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
7532 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
7533 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
7534 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
7535 a value from memory).
7538 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
7539 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
7540 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
7541 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
7542 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
7544 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
7545 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
7546 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
7547 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
7548 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
7550 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
7551 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
7552 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
7553 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
7554 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
7555 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
7556 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
7557 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
7558 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
7560 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
7561 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
7562 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
7563 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
7564 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
7565 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
7566 for successive uses of @code{x}.
7568 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
7569 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
7572 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
7573 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
7574 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
7575 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
7576 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
7577 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
7580 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
7581 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
7582 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
7583 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
7584 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
7585 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
7586 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
7587 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
7588 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
7590 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
7591 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
7592 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
7594 @cindex remote memory comparison
7595 @cindex verify remote memory image
7596 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
7597 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
7598 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
7599 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
7603 @kindex compare-sections
7604 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
7605 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
7606 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
7607 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
7608 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
7609 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
7614 @section Automatic Display
7615 @cindex automatic display
7616 @cindex display of expressions
7618 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
7619 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
7620 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
7621 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
7622 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
7623 The automatic display looks like this:
7627 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
7631 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
7632 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
7633 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
7634 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
7635 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
7636 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
7640 @item display @var{expr}
7641 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
7642 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7644 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
7646 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7647 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7648 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7649 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7650 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7652 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7653 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7654 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7655 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7656 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7659 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7660 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7661 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7664 @kindex delete display
7666 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7667 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7668 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
7670 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7671 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7673 @kindex disable display
7674 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7675 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7676 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7677 enabled again later.
7679 @kindex enable display
7680 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7681 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7682 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7685 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7686 done when your program stops.
7688 @kindex info display
7690 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7691 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7692 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7693 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7694 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7697 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7698 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7699 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7700 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7701 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7702 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7703 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7704 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7705 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7706 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7707 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7709 @node Print Settings
7710 @section Print Settings
7712 @cindex format options
7713 @cindex print settings
7714 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7715 and symbols are printed.
7718 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7722 @item set print address
7723 @itemx set print address on
7724 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7725 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7726 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7727 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7728 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7729 @code{set print address on}:
7734 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7736 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7740 @item set print address off
7741 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7742 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7746 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7748 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7749 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7753 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7754 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7755 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7756 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7759 @item show print address
7760 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7763 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7764 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7765 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7766 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7767 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7768 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7769 it prints a symbolic address:
7772 @item set print symbol-filename on
7773 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7774 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7775 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7776 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7778 @item set print symbol-filename off
7779 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7782 @item show print symbol-filename
7783 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7784 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7787 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7788 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7789 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7791 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7792 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7795 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7796 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7797 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7798 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7799 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7800 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7802 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7803 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7807 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7808 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7809 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7810 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7811 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7812 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7813 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7814 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7817 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7818 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7819 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7823 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7824 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7825 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7828 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7831 @item set print array
7832 @itemx set print array on
7833 @cindex pretty print arrays
7834 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7835 but uses more space. The default is off.
7837 @item set print array off
7838 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7840 @item show print array
7841 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7844 @cindex print array indexes
7845 @item set print array-indexes
7846 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7847 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7848 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7849 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7851 @item set print array-indexes off
7852 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7854 @item show print array-indexes
7855 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7858 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7859 @cindex number of array elements to print
7860 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7861 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7862 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7863 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7864 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7865 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7866 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7868 @item show print elements
7869 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7870 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7872 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7873 @kindex set print frame-arguments
7874 @cindex printing frame argument values
7875 @cindex print all frame argument values
7876 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7877 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7878 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7879 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7884 The values of all arguments are printed.
7887 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7888 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7889 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7890 only scalar arguments are shown:
7893 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7898 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7899 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7902 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7907 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7908 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7909 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7910 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7911 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7912 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7913 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7914 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7915 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7916 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7918 @item show print frame-arguments
7919 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7921 @item set print repeats
7922 @cindex repeated array elements
7923 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7924 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7925 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7926 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7927 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7928 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7929 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7931 @item show print repeats
7932 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7935 @item set print null-stop
7936 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7937 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7938 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7939 contain only short strings.
7942 @item show print null-stop
7943 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7944 @sc{null} character.
7946 @item set print pretty on
7947 @cindex print structures in indented form
7948 @cindex indentation in structure display
7949 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7950 per line, like this:
7965 @item set print pretty off
7966 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7970 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7971 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7976 This is the default format.
7978 @item show print pretty
7979 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7981 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7982 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7983 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7984 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7985 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7986 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7987 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7988 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7990 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7991 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7992 international character sets, and is the default.
7994 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7995 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7997 @item set print union on
7998 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7999 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
8000 and other unions. This is the default setting.
8002 @item set print union off
8003 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
8004 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
8007 @item show print union
8008 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
8009 structures and other unions.
8011 For example, given the declarations
8014 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
8015 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
8016 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
8027 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
8031 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
8034 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
8038 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
8041 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
8045 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
8051 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
8054 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
8055 @item set print demangle
8056 @itemx set print demangle on
8057 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
8058 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
8059 linkage. The default is on.
8061 @item show print demangle
8062 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
8064 @item set print asm-demangle
8065 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
8066 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
8067 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
8070 @item show print asm-demangle
8071 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
8074 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
8075 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
8076 @kindex set demangle-style
8077 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
8078 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
8079 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
8083 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
8086 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
8087 This is the default.
8090 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
8093 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
8096 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
8097 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
8098 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
8099 require further enhancement to permit that.
8102 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
8104 @item show demangle-style
8105 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
8107 @item set print object
8108 @itemx set print object on
8109 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
8110 @cindex display derived types
8111 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
8112 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
8113 the virtual function table.
8115 @item set print object off
8116 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
8117 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
8119 @item show print object
8120 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
8122 @item set print static-members
8123 @itemx set print static-members on
8124 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
8125 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
8127 @item set print static-members off
8128 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
8130 @item show print static-members
8131 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
8133 @item set print pascal_static-members
8134 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
8135 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
8136 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
8137 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
8139 @item set print pascal_static-members off
8140 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
8142 @item show print pascal_static-members
8143 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
8145 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
8146 @item set print vtbl
8147 @itemx set print vtbl on
8148 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
8149 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
8150 @cindex VTBL display
8151 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
8152 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8153 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8155 @item set print vtbl off
8156 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
8158 @item show print vtbl
8159 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
8162 @node Pretty Printing
8163 @section Pretty Printing
8165 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
8166 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
8167 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
8170 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
8171 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
8172 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
8175 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
8176 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
8178 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
8179 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
8180 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
8182 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
8183 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
8184 pretty-printers with their names.
8185 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
8186 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
8187 Each such subprinter has its own name.
8188 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
8190 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
8191 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
8192 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
8193 do anything special.
8195 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
8199 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
8203 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
8204 when debugging that program.
8205 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
8208 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
8209 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
8210 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
8213 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
8214 pretty-printers are selected,
8216 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
8219 @node Pretty-Printer Example
8220 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
8222 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
8225 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8227 static npos = 4294967295,
8229 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
8230 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
8231 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
8233 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
8234 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
8235 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
8240 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
8243 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8247 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
8248 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
8249 @cindex pretty-printer commands
8252 @kindex info pretty-printer
8253 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8254 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
8255 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
8257 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
8258 whose pretty-printers to list.
8259 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
8260 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
8261 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
8262 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
8263 looks up a printer from these three objects.
8265 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
8268 @kindex disable pretty-printer
8269 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8270 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8271 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
8273 @kindex enable pretty-printer
8274 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8275 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8280 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
8281 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
8282 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
8283 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
8286 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8293 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8298 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
8300 2 of 3 printers enabled
8301 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8308 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
8310 1 of 3 printers enabled
8311 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8318 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
8320 0 of 3 printers enabled
8321 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8330 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
8331 as can each individual subprinter.
8334 @section Value History
8336 @cindex value history
8337 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
8338 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
8339 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
8340 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
8341 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
8342 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
8343 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
8348 @cindex history number
8349 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
8350 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
8351 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
8352 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
8355 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
8356 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
8357 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
8358 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
8359 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
8360 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
8361 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
8363 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
8364 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
8370 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
8371 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
8378 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
8379 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
8381 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
8382 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
8390 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
8391 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
8396 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
8397 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
8398 values} does not change the history.
8400 @item show values @var{n}
8401 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
8404 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
8405 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
8408 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
8409 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
8411 @node Convenience Vars
8412 @section Convenience Variables
8414 @cindex convenience variables
8415 @cindex user-defined variables
8416 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
8417 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
8418 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
8419 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
8420 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
8422 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
8423 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
8424 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8425 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
8426 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
8428 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
8429 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
8433 set $foo = *object_ptr
8437 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
8440 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
8441 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
8442 value with another assignment at any time.
8444 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
8445 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
8446 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
8447 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
8450 @kindex show convenience
8451 @cindex show all user variables
8452 @item show convenience
8453 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
8454 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
8456 @kindex init-if-undefined
8457 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
8458 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
8459 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
8460 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
8461 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
8462 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
8463 override default values used in a command script.
8465 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
8466 any side-effects do not occur.
8469 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
8470 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
8471 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
8475 print bar[$i++]->contents
8479 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
8481 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
8482 values likely to be useful.
8485 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
8487 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
8488 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
8489 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
8490 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
8491 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
8492 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
8493 to the type of @code{$__}.
8495 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
8497 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
8498 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
8499 to match the format in which the data was printed.
8502 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
8503 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
8504 the program being debugged terminates.
8507 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
8508 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
8509 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
8510 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
8511 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
8514 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
8515 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
8516 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
8517 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
8518 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
8521 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
8522 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
8523 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
8524 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
8525 @xref{General Query Packets}.
8526 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
8530 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
8531 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
8532 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
8534 @cindex convenience functions
8535 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
8536 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
8537 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
8538 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
8543 @kindex help function
8544 @cindex show all convenience functions
8545 Print a list of all convenience functions.
8552 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
8553 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
8554 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
8558 @kindex info registers
8559 @item info registers
8560 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
8561 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8563 @kindex info all-registers
8564 @cindex floating point registers
8565 @item info all-registers
8566 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
8567 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8569 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
8570 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
8571 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
8572 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
8573 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
8576 @cindex stack pointer register
8577 @cindex program counter register
8578 @cindex process status register
8579 @cindex frame pointer register
8580 @cindex standard registers
8581 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
8582 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
8583 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
8584 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
8585 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
8586 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
8587 register that contains the processor status. For example,
8588 you could print the program counter in hex with
8595 or print the instruction to be executed next with
8602 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
8603 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
8604 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
8605 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
8606 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
8607 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
8608 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
8614 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
8615 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
8616 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
8617 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
8618 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
8619 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
8620 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
8622 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
8623 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
8624 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
8625 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
8626 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
8627 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
8628 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
8630 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
8631 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
8632 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
8633 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
8634 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
8635 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
8636 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
8637 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
8638 prints the data in both formats.
8640 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
8641 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
8642 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
8643 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
8644 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
8645 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
8646 registers in @code{struct} notation:
8649 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
8651 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
8652 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
8653 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
8654 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
8655 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
8656 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
8657 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
8662 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
8663 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
8664 value to a @code{struct} member:
8667 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
8670 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
8671 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
8672 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
8673 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
8674 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
8675 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
8677 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
8678 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
8679 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
8680 frame makes no difference.
8682 @node Floating Point Hardware
8683 @section Floating Point Hardware
8684 @cindex floating point
8686 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
8687 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
8692 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
8693 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
8694 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
8695 the ARM and x86 machines.
8699 @section Vector Unit
8702 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
8703 more information about the status of the vector unit.
8708 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
8709 layout vary depending on the hardware.
8712 @node OS Information
8713 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
8714 @cindex OS information
8716 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
8717 you debug your program.
8719 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
8720 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
8721 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
8722 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
8723 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
8724 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
8725 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
8731 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
8732 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
8733 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
8734 the @code{examine} command.
8737 @cindex auxiliary vector
8738 @cindex vector, auxiliary
8739 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
8740 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
8741 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
8742 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
8743 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
8744 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
8745 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
8746 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
8747 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
8748 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
8749 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
8754 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
8755 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
8756 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
8757 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
8758 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
8759 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
8760 an unrecognized tag.
8763 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
8764 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
8765 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
8766 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
8771 List the types of OS information available for the target. If the
8772 target does not return a list of possible types, this command will
8775 @kindex info os processes
8776 @item info os processes
8777 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
8778 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
8779 the command corresponding to the process.
8782 @node Memory Region Attributes
8783 @section Memory Region Attributes
8784 @cindex memory region attributes
8786 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
8787 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
8788 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
8789 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
8790 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
8791 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
8792 user can override the fetched regions.
8794 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
8795 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
8796 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
8797 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
8800 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
8801 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
8805 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
8806 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
8807 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
8808 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
8809 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
8810 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
8813 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
8814 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
8817 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8818 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
8819 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
8822 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8823 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8824 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
8825 It may be enabled again later.
8828 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8829 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8833 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
8837 @item Memory Region Number
8838 @item Enabled or Disabled.
8839 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
8840 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
8843 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
8846 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
8849 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
8854 @subsection Attributes
8856 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
8857 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
8858 write accesses to a memory region.
8860 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
8861 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
8862 etc.@: from accessing memory.
8866 Memory is read only.
8868 Memory is write only.
8870 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
8873 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
8874 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
8875 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
8876 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
8877 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
8881 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
8883 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
8885 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
8887 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
8890 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
8891 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8892 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
8893 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
8897 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
8898 @c @item swbreak (default)
8901 @subsubsection Data Cache
8902 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
8903 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
8904 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
8905 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
8910 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
8912 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
8915 @subsection Memory Access Checking
8916 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
8917 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
8918 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
8919 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
8922 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
8923 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
8924 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
8925 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
8926 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
8927 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
8928 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
8929 The default value is @code{on}.
8930 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
8931 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
8932 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
8936 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
8937 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8938 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
8942 @c @item noverify (default)
8945 @node Dump/Restore Files
8946 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
8947 @cindex dump/restore files
8948 @cindex append data to a file
8949 @cindex dump data to a file
8950 @cindex restore data from a file
8952 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
8953 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
8954 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
8955 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
8956 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8957 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8963 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8964 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8965 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8966 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8968 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8975 Motorola S-record format.
8977 Tektronix Hex format.
8980 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8981 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8982 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8986 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8987 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8988 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8989 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8990 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8993 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8994 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8995 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8996 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8997 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8999 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
9000 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
9001 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
9002 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
9005 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
9006 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
9007 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
9008 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
9012 @node Core File Generation
9013 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
9014 @cindex dump core from inferior
9016 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
9017 image of a running process and its process status (register values
9018 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
9019 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
9020 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
9021 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
9022 the post-mortem debugging mode.
9024 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
9025 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
9026 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
9030 @kindex generate-core-file
9031 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
9032 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
9033 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
9034 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
9035 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
9036 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
9038 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
9039 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
9042 @node Character Sets
9043 @section Character Sets
9044 @cindex character sets
9046 @cindex translating between character sets
9047 @cindex host character set
9048 @cindex target character set
9050 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
9051 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
9052 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
9053 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
9054 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
9055 @dfn{target character set}.
9057 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
9058 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
9059 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
9060 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
9061 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
9062 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
9063 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
9064 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
9065 character and string literals in expressions.
9067 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
9068 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
9069 target-charset} command, described below.
9071 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
9075 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
9076 @kindex set target-charset
9077 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
9078 list of supported target character sets, type
9079 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9081 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
9082 @kindex set host-charset
9083 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
9085 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
9086 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
9087 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
9088 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
9089 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
9091 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
9092 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9093 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
9095 @item set charset @var{charset}
9097 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
9098 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9099 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
9100 for both host and target.
9103 @kindex show charset
9104 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
9106 @item show host-charset
9107 @kindex show host-charset
9108 Show the name of the current host character set.
9110 @item show target-charset
9111 @kindex show target-charset
9112 Show the name of the current target character set.
9114 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
9115 @kindex set target-wide-charset
9116 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
9117 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
9118 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
9119 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9121 @item show target-wide-charset
9122 @kindex show target-wide-charset
9123 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
9126 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
9127 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
9128 @file{charset-test.c}:
9134 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
9135 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
9136 char ibm1047_hello[]
9137 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
9138 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
9142 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9146 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
9147 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
9148 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
9150 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
9153 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
9154 $ gdb -nw charset-test
9155 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
9156 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9161 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
9162 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
9166 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9167 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
9171 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
9172 initial character set:
9174 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
9175 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9176 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
9180 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
9181 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
9182 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
9183 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
9184 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
9187 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9188 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
9189 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9194 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
9195 literals you use in expressions:
9198 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9203 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
9206 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
9207 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
9208 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
9211 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9212 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
9213 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9218 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
9219 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
9222 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9223 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
9224 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9227 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
9228 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
9229 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
9230 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
9231 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
9234 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
9235 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9236 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
9237 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
9238 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9239 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
9240 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9242 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9243 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
9244 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9249 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
9250 string literals you use in expressions:
9253 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9258 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
9261 @node Caching Remote Data
9262 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
9263 @cindex caching data of remote targets
9265 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
9266 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
9267 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
9268 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
9269 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
9270 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
9271 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
9272 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
9273 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
9274 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
9275 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
9276 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
9277 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
9278 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
9279 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
9282 @kindex set remotecache
9283 @item set remotecache on
9284 @itemx set remotecache off
9285 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
9288 @kindex show remotecache
9289 @item show remotecache
9290 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
9292 @kindex set stack-cache
9293 @item set stack-cache on
9294 @itemx set stack-cache off
9295 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
9296 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
9298 @kindex show stack-cache
9299 @item show stack-cache
9300 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
9303 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
9304 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
9305 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
9306 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
9307 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
9310 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
9314 @node Searching Memory
9315 @section Search Memory
9316 @cindex searching memory
9318 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
9319 @code{find} command.
9323 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9324 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9325 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
9326 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
9327 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
9330 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
9331 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
9334 @item @var{s}, search query size
9335 The size of each search query value.
9341 halfwords (two bytes)
9345 giant words (eight bytes)
9348 All values are interpreted in the current language.
9349 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
9350 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
9352 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
9353 value's type in the current language.
9354 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
9355 pattern as a mixture of types.
9356 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
9357 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
9358 which is typically four bytes.
9360 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
9361 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
9364 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
9366 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
9367 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
9369 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
9370 number of matches found.
9372 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
9374 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
9376 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
9382 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
9383 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
9384 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
9385 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
9386 printf ("%s\n", hello);
9391 you get during debugging:
9394 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
9395 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9397 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
9398 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9399 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9401 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
9402 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9404 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
9405 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
9407 (gdb) print $numfound
9410 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
9413 @node Optimized Code
9414 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
9415 @cindex optimized code, debugging
9416 @cindex debugging optimized code
9418 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
9419 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
9420 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
9421 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
9422 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
9423 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
9424 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
9426 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
9427 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
9428 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
9429 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
9431 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
9432 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
9433 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
9434 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
9435 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
9436 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
9438 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
9439 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
9440 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
9441 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
9442 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
9445 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
9448 @node Inline Functions
9449 @section Inline Functions
9450 @cindex inline functions, debugging
9452 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
9453 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
9454 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
9455 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
9456 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
9457 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
9458 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
9459 @code{info frame} command.
9461 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
9462 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
9463 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
9464 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
9465 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
9466 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
9467 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
9468 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
9469 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
9470 local variables in the caller.
9472 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
9473 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
9474 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
9475 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
9476 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
9477 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
9478 instructions are executed.
9480 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
9481 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
9482 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
9483 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
9485 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
9486 function calls are the same as normal calls:
9490 You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
9491 either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
9492 breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
9493 will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
9494 set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
9498 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
9499 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
9500 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
9501 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
9502 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
9503 or inside the inlined function instead.
9506 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
9507 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
9508 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
9509 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
9515 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
9517 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
9518 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
9519 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
9520 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
9521 where it was defined.
9523 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
9524 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
9525 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
9526 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
9528 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
9529 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
9530 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
9531 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
9532 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
9533 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
9536 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
9537 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
9538 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
9542 @kindex macro expand
9543 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
9544 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
9545 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
9546 @item macro expand @var{expression}
9547 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
9548 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
9549 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
9550 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
9551 it can be any string of tokens.
9554 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
9555 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
9556 @cindex expand macro once
9557 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
9558 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
9559 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
9560 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
9561 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
9562 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
9563 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
9564 can be any string of tokens.
9567 @cindex macro definition, showing
9568 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
9569 @item info macro @var{macro}
9570 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
9571 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
9573 @kindex macro define
9574 @cindex user-defined macros
9575 @cindex defining macros interactively
9576 @cindex macros, user-defined
9577 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
9578 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
9579 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
9580 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
9581 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
9582 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
9583 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
9586 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
9587 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
9588 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
9589 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
9590 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
9593 @item macro undef @var{macro}
9594 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
9595 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
9596 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
9597 in the program being debugged.
9601 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
9604 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
9605 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
9606 show our source files:
9614 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9619 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9621 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9623 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9630 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
9631 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
9632 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
9636 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
9640 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
9644 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
9645 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9646 GDB is free software, @dots{}
9650 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
9651 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
9652 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
9655 (@value{GDBP}) list main
9658 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9663 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9665 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9666 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
9667 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
9668 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9669 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
9670 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
9671 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
9673 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
9674 expands to: (42 + 1)
9675 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
9676 expands to: once (M + 1)
9680 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
9681 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
9682 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
9683 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
9685 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
9686 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
9689 (@value{GDBP}) break main
9690 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
9692 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
9694 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
9695 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9699 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
9702 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9703 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
9705 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9707 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9712 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
9713 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
9714 thereof) in force at each point:
9719 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9720 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9721 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
9722 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
9725 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9726 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9727 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
9729 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9730 expands to: 1729 < 42
9731 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9736 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
9737 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
9738 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
9739 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
9742 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
9743 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
9750 @chapter Tracepoints
9751 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
9752 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
9755 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
9756 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
9757 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
9758 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
9759 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
9760 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
9761 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
9763 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
9764 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
9765 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
9766 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
9767 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
9768 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
9769 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
9770 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
9771 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
9772 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
9773 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
9775 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
9776 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
9777 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
9778 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
9779 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
9780 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
9783 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
9784 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
9785 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
9787 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
9791 * Analyze Collected Data::
9792 * Tracepoint Variables::
9796 @node Set Tracepoints
9797 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
9799 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
9800 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
9801 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
9802 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
9803 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
9804 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
9805 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
9807 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
9808 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
9809 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
9810 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
9811 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
9814 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
9815 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
9816 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
9819 @cindex fast tracepoints
9820 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
9821 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
9822 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
9824 @cindex static tracepoints
9825 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
9826 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
9827 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
9828 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
9829 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
9830 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
9831 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
9832 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
9833 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
9834 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
9835 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
9836 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
9837 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
9838 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namelly, support for collecting
9839 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
9840 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
9841 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
9842 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
9843 static tracepoint marker.
9845 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
9846 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
9848 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
9849 conditions and actions.
9852 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
9853 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
9854 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
9855 * Tracepoint Conditions::
9856 * Trace State Variables::
9857 * Tracepoint Actions::
9858 * Listing Tracepoints::
9859 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
9860 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
9861 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
9864 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
9865 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
9868 @cindex set tracepoint
9870 @item trace @var{location}
9871 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
9872 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
9873 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
9874 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
9875 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
9876 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
9877 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
9878 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
9879 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
9881 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
9884 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
9886 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
9888 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
9890 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
9892 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
9896 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
9898 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
9899 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
9900 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
9901 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
9902 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
9903 information on tracepoint conditions.
9905 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9906 @cindex set fast tracepoint
9907 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
9909 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
9910 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
9911 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
9912 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
9913 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
9914 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
9917 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
9920 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9921 @cindex set static tracepoint
9922 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
9923 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
9925 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
9926 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
9927 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
9928 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
9929 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
9931 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
9932 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
9933 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
9934 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
9935 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
9936 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
9937 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
9938 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
9939 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
9945 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
9950 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
9951 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
9954 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
9955 Cnt Enb ID Address What
9956 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
9962 so you may probe the marker above with:
9965 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
9968 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
9969 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
9970 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
9971 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
9972 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
9973 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
9974 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
9975 the @samp{Data:} field.
9977 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
9978 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
9979 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
9982 @cindex last tracepoint number
9983 @cindex recent tracepoint number
9984 @cindex tracepoint number
9985 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
9986 of the most recently set tracepoint.
9988 @kindex delete tracepoint
9989 @cindex tracepoint deletion
9990 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9991 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
9992 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
9993 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
9998 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
10000 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
10004 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
10007 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
10008 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
10010 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
10013 @kindex disable tracepoint
10014 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10015 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
10016 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
10017 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
10018 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
10020 @kindex enable tracepoint
10021 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10022 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
10023 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
10027 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
10028 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
10032 @cindex tracepoint pass count
10033 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
10034 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
10035 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
10036 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
10037 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
10038 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
10039 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
10040 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
10046 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
10047 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
10049 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
10050 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
10051 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10052 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
10053 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
10054 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
10055 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
10056 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
10057 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
10058 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
10059 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
10063 @node Tracepoint Conditions
10064 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
10065 @cindex conditional tracepoints
10066 @cindex tracepoint conditions
10068 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
10069 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
10070 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
10071 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
10072 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
10073 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
10076 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
10077 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
10078 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
10079 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
10080 just as with breakpoints.
10082 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
10083 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
10084 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}
10085 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
10086 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
10087 accesses, and so forth.
10089 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
10090 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
10091 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
10092 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
10093 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
10094 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
10098 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
10101 @node Trace State Variables
10102 @subsection Trace State Variables
10103 @cindex trace state variables
10105 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
10106 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
10107 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
10108 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
10109 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
10112 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
10113 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
10114 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
10115 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
10117 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
10118 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
10119 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
10120 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
10121 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
10122 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
10123 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
10124 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
10125 variable with the same name.
10129 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
10131 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
10132 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
10133 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
10134 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
10135 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
10136 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
10137 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
10138 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
10139 value. The default initial value is 0.
10141 @item info tvariables
10142 @kindex info tvariables
10143 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
10144 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
10147 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
10148 @kindex delete tvariable
10149 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
10154 @node Tracepoint Actions
10155 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
10159 @cindex tracepoint actions
10160 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10161 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
10162 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
10163 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
10164 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
10165 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
10166 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
10167 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
10168 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
10169 @code{while-stepping}.
10171 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
10172 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
10173 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
10175 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
10176 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
10177 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
10180 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
10182 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
10184 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
10187 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
10188 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
10189 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
10190 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
10191 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
10192 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
10193 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
10194 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
10197 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10198 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10199 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
10202 > while-stepping 12
10203 > collect $pc, arr[i]
10208 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
10209 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10210 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
10211 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
10212 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
10213 special arguments are supported:
10217 Collect all registers.
10220 Collect all function arguments.
10223 Collect all local variables.
10226 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
10227 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
10228 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
10229 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
10230 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
10231 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
10232 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
10233 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
10234 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
10237 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
10238 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
10241 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
10242 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
10243 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
10247 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
10248 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
10249 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
10251 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
10252 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
10254 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
10255 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10256 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
10257 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
10258 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
10259 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
10260 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
10263 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
10264 @item while-stepping @var{n}
10265 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
10266 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
10267 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
10268 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
10271 > while-stepping 12
10272 > collect $regs, myglobal
10278 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
10279 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
10280 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
10283 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10284 @kindex set default-collect
10285 @cindex default collection action
10286 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
10287 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
10288 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
10289 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
10290 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
10291 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
10293 @item show default-collect
10294 @kindex show default-collect
10295 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
10300 @node Listing Tracepoints
10301 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
10304 @kindex info tracepoints
10306 @cindex information about tracepoints
10307 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10308 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
10309 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
10310 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
10311 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
10312 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
10314 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
10319 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
10323 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
10324 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
10325 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
10327 collect globfoo, $regs
10336 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
10339 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10340 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10343 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
10344 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
10345 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
10346 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
10349 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
10353 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
10356 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
10357 @item Enabled or Disabled
10358 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
10359 that are not enabled.
10361 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
10363 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
10364 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
10365 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
10366 will be left blank.
10370 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
10374 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
10375 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
10377 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
10378 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
10382 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
10383 Cnt ID Enb Address What
10384 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
10385 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
10386 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
10387 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
10393 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10394 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10398 @cindex start a new trace experiment
10399 @cindex collected data discarded
10401 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
10402 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
10403 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
10407 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
10409 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
10410 stops collecting data.
10412 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
10413 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
10414 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
10417 @cindex status of trace data collection
10418 @cindex trace experiment, status of
10420 This command displays the status of the current trace data
10424 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
10427 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
10428 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10429 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
10430 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
10431 > while-stepping 11
10435 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10436 [time passes @dots{}]
10437 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
10440 @cindex disconnected tracing
10441 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
10442 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
10443 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
10444 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
10445 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
10446 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
10447 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
10448 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
10451 @item set disconnected-tracing on
10452 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
10453 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
10454 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
10455 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
10456 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
10457 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
10458 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
10460 @item show disconnected-tracing
10461 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
10462 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
10466 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
10467 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
10468 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
10469 it will continue after reconnection.
10471 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
10472 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
10473 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
10474 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
10475 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
10476 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
10477 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
10478 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
10479 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
10480 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
10482 @cindex circular trace buffer
10483 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
10484 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
10485 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
10486 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
10487 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
10488 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
10489 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
10490 @samp{circular_trace_buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
10491 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
10492 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
10496 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
10497 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
10498 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
10499 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
10500 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
10501 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
10502 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
10504 @item show circular-trace-buffer
10505 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
10506 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
10507 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
10508 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
10509 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
10513 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
10514 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
10516 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
10517 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
10518 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
10519 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
10520 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
10521 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
10522 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
10523 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
10529 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
10530 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
10531 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
10532 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
10533 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
10534 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
10535 cannot be collected either.
10538 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
10539 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
10540 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
10541 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
10542 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
10543 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
10544 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
10545 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
10546 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
10547 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
10550 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
10551 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
10552 in a misleading way.
10555 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
10556 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
10557 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
10558 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
10559 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
10560 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
10561 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
10565 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
10566 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
10567 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*$esp@@300}
10568 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
10569 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
10570 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
10571 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
10572 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
10573 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
10574 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
10578 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
10579 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
10580 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
10581 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
10582 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
10583 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
10584 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
10589 @node Analyze Collected Data
10590 @section Using the Collected Data
10592 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
10593 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
10594 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
10595 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
10596 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
10597 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
10598 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
10599 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
10600 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
10601 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
10602 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
10603 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
10604 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
10605 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
10606 the buffer will fail.
10609 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
10610 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
10611 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
10615 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
10618 @cindex select trace snapshot
10619 @cindex find trace snapshot
10620 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
10621 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
10622 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
10623 snapshot is selected.
10625 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
10629 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
10630 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
10633 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
10636 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
10639 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
10642 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
10643 retracing earlier steps.
10645 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
10646 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
10647 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
10648 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
10649 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
10651 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
10652 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
10653 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
10654 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
10655 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
10657 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10658 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
10659 addresses (exclusive).
10661 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10662 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
10663 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
10665 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
10666 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
10667 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
10668 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
10669 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
10670 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
10671 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
10672 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
10675 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
10676 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
10677 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
10678 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
10679 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
10680 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
10681 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
10682 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
10683 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
10684 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
10685 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
10686 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
10687 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
10688 tracepoint as the current one.
10690 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
10691 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
10692 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
10693 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
10694 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
10697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10699 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
10700 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
10704 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
10705 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
10706 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
10707 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
10708 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
10709 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
10710 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
10711 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
10712 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
10713 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
10714 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
10717 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
10721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10723 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
10733 @subsection @code{tdump}
10735 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
10736 @cindex tracepoint data, display
10738 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
10739 the current trace snapshot.
10742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
10743 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10744 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
10745 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
10748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
10751 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
10753 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
10755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
10756 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
10757 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
10761 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
10764 d7 0x380035 3670069
10765 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
10766 a1 0x3000668 50333288
10768 a3 0x322000 3284992
10769 a4 0x3000698 50333336
10770 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
10771 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
10772 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
10774 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
10778 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
10785 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
10790 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
10791 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
10792 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
10793 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
10795 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
10796 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
10797 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
10798 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
10799 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
10800 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
10801 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
10802 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
10803 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
10804 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
10806 @node save tracepoints
10807 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
10808 @kindex save tracepoints
10809 @kindex save-tracepoints
10810 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
10812 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
10813 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
10814 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
10815 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
10816 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
10817 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
10819 @node Tracepoint Variables
10820 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
10821 @cindex tracepoint variables
10822 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
10825 @vindex $trace_frame
10826 @item (int) $trace_frame
10827 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
10828 snapshot is selected.
10830 @vindex $tracepoint
10831 @item (int) $tracepoint
10832 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
10834 @vindex $trace_line
10835 @item (int) $trace_line
10836 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
10838 @vindex $trace_file
10839 @item (char []) $trace_file
10840 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
10842 @vindex $trace_func
10843 @item (char []) $trace_func
10844 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
10847 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
10848 use @code{output} instead.
10850 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
10851 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
10852 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
10853 which are managed by the target.
10856 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10858 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
10859 > output $trace_file
10860 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
10866 @section Using Trace Files
10867 @cindex trace files
10869 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
10870 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
10871 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
10872 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
10873 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
10878 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
10879 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
10880 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
10881 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
10882 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
10883 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
10884 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
10885 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
10886 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
10888 @kindex target tfile
10890 @item target tfile @var{filename}
10891 Use the file named @var{filename} as a source of trace data. Commands
10892 that examine data work as they do with a live target, but it is not
10893 possible to run any new trace experiments. @code{tstatus} will report
10894 the state of the trace run at the moment the data was saved, as well
10895 as the current trace frame you are examining. @var{filename} must be
10896 on a filesystem accessible to the host.
10901 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
10904 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
10905 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
10906 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
10910 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
10911 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
10912 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
10913 mapped by asking the inferior.
10914 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
10917 @node How Overlays Work
10918 @section How Overlays Work
10919 @cindex mapped overlays
10920 @cindex unmapped overlays
10921 @cindex load address, overlay's
10922 @cindex mapped address
10923 @cindex overlay area
10925 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
10926 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
10927 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
10928 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
10929 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
10931 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
10932 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
10933 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
10934 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
10935 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
10936 largest overlay as well.
10938 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
10939 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
10940 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
10943 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
10944 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
10945 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
10949 Data Instruction Larger
10950 Address Space Address Space Address Space
10951 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
10953 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
10954 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
10955 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
10956 | and heap | | | | | |
10957 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
10958 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
10959 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
10961 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
10962 address | | | | | |
10963 | overlay | <-' | | |
10964 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
10965 | | <---. | | load address
10966 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
10973 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
10977 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
10978 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
10979 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
10980 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
10981 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
10982 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
10983 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
10984 program and the overlay area.
10986 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
10987 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
10988 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
10989 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
10990 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
10991 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
10992 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
10994 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
10995 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
10996 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
11001 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
11002 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
11003 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
11004 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
11007 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
11008 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
11009 your program's performance.
11012 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
11013 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
11014 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
11015 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
11016 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
11017 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
11018 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
11021 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
11022 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
11023 instruction and data spaces.
11027 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
11028 improved in many ways:
11033 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
11034 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
11035 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
11036 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
11037 area in the usual way.
11040 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
11041 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
11044 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
11045 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
11046 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
11047 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
11048 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
11049 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
11050 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
11055 @node Overlay Commands
11056 @section Overlay Commands
11058 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
11059 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
11060 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
11061 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
11062 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
11063 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
11065 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
11066 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
11071 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
11072 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
11073 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
11074 overlay support is disabled.
11076 @item overlay manual
11077 @cindex manual overlay debugging
11078 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11079 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
11080 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
11081 commands described below.
11083 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
11084 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
11085 @cindex map an overlay
11086 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
11087 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
11088 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
11089 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
11090 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
11091 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
11093 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
11094 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
11095 @cindex unmap an overlay
11096 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
11097 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
11098 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
11099 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
11102 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11103 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
11104 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
11105 Overlay Debugging}.
11107 @item overlay load-target
11108 @itemx overlay load
11109 @cindex reloading the overlay table
11110 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
11111 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
11112 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
11113 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
11114 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
11116 @item overlay list-overlays
11117 @itemx overlay list
11118 @cindex listing mapped overlays
11119 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
11120 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
11124 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
11125 of the function the address falls in:
11128 (@value{GDBP}) print main
11129 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
11132 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
11133 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
11134 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
11135 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
11138 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11139 No sections are mapped.
11140 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11141 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
11144 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
11148 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11149 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
11150 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
11151 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11152 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
11155 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
11156 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
11157 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
11158 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
11159 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
11163 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
11164 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
11165 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
11166 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
11168 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
11169 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
11170 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
11171 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
11172 breakpoints properly.
11176 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
11177 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
11178 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
11180 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
11181 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
11182 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
11183 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
11184 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
11185 current state of the overlays.
11187 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
11188 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
11192 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
11193 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
11198 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
11201 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
11202 unsigned long size;
11204 /* The overlay's load address. */
11207 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
11209 unsigned long mapped;
11213 @item @code{_novlys}:
11214 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
11215 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
11219 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
11220 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
11221 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
11222 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
11223 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
11226 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
11227 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
11228 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
11229 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
11230 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
11231 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
11232 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
11233 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
11234 are not being executed.
11236 @node Overlay Sample Program
11237 @section Overlay Sample Program
11238 @cindex overlay example program
11240 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
11241 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
11242 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
11243 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
11244 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
11245 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
11246 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
11248 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
11249 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
11250 suite. The program consists of the following files from
11251 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
11255 The main program file.
11257 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
11262 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
11265 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
11266 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
11269 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
11270 cross-compiler like this:
11273 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
11274 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
11275 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
11276 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
11277 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
11278 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
11279 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
11280 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
11283 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
11284 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
11285 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
11289 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
11292 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
11293 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
11294 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
11295 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
11296 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
11297 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
11299 @cindex working language
11300 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
11301 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
11302 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
11303 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
11304 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
11308 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
11309 * Show:: Displaying the language
11310 * Checks:: Type and range checks
11311 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
11312 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
11316 @section Switching Between Source Languages
11318 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
11319 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
11320 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
11321 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
11322 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
11325 In addition to the working language, every source file that
11326 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
11327 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
11328 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
11329 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
11330 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
11331 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
11332 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
11333 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
11334 Displaying the Language}.
11336 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
11337 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
11338 another language. In that case, make the
11339 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
11340 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
11341 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
11344 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
11345 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
11346 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
11350 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
11352 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
11353 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
11371 C@t{++} source file
11377 Objective-C source file
11381 Fortran source file
11384 Modula-2 source file
11388 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
11389 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
11392 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
11393 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
11396 @subsection Setting the Working Language
11398 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
11399 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
11402 @kindex set language
11403 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
11404 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
11405 a language, such as
11406 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
11407 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
11409 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
11410 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
11411 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
11412 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
11413 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
11414 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
11422 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
11423 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
11424 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
11425 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
11427 @node Automatically
11428 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
11430 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
11431 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
11432 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
11433 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
11434 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
11435 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
11436 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
11437 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
11438 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
11440 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
11441 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
11442 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
11443 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
11444 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
11447 @section Displaying the Language
11449 The following commands help you find out which language is the
11450 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
11453 @item show language
11454 @kindex show language
11455 Display the current working language. This is the
11456 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
11457 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
11460 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
11461 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
11462 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
11463 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
11464 information listed here.
11467 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
11468 Display the source language of this source file.
11469 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
11470 information listed here.
11473 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
11474 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
11475 with a language explicitly:
11478 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
11479 @kindex set extension-language
11480 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
11481 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
11483 @item info extensions
11484 @kindex info extensions
11485 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
11489 @section Type and Range Checking
11492 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
11493 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
11494 section documents the intended facilities.
11496 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
11498 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
11499 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
11500 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
11501 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
11502 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
11503 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
11504 errors when your program is running.
11506 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
11507 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
11508 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
11509 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
11510 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
11511 automatically based on your program's source language.
11512 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
11513 settings of supported languages.
11516 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
11517 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
11520 @cindex type checking
11521 @cindex checks, type
11522 @node Type Checking
11523 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
11525 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
11526 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
11527 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
11528 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
11536 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
11537 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
11539 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
11540 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
11541 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
11542 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
11543 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
11544 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
11545 also issues a warning.
11547 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
11548 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
11549 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
11550 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
11551 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
11552 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
11554 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
11555 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
11556 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
11557 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
11558 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
11559 details on specific languages.
11561 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
11563 @kindex set check type
11564 @kindex show check type
11566 @item set check type auto
11567 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
11568 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11571 @item set check type on
11572 @itemx set check type off
11573 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11574 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
11575 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
11576 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
11577 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
11579 @item set check type warn
11580 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
11581 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
11582 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
11583 numbers and structures.
11586 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
11587 is setting it automatically.
11590 @cindex range checking
11591 @cindex checks, range
11592 @node Range Checking
11593 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
11595 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
11596 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
11597 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
11598 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
11599 not exceed the bounds of the array.
11601 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
11602 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
11603 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
11604 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
11606 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
11607 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
11608 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
11609 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
11610 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
11611 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
11614 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
11617 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
11618 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
11619 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
11621 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
11623 @kindex set check range
11624 @kindex show check range
11626 @item set check range auto
11627 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
11628 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11631 @item set check range on
11632 @itemx set check range off
11633 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11634 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
11635 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
11636 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
11638 @item set check range warn
11639 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
11640 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
11641 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
11642 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
11646 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
11647 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
11650 @node Supported Languages
11651 @section Supported Languages
11653 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, OpenCL C, Pascal,
11654 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
11655 @c This is false ...
11656 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
11657 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
11658 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
11659 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
11662 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
11663 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
11664 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
11665 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
11666 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
11667 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
11668 language reference or tutorial.
11671 * C:: C and C@t{++}
11673 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
11674 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
11675 * Fortran:: Fortran
11677 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
11682 @subsection C and C@t{++}
11684 @cindex C and C@t{++}
11685 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
11687 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
11688 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
11692 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
11693 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
11694 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
11695 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
11696 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
11697 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
11698 compiler (@code{aCC}).
11700 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
11701 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
11702 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
11703 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
11704 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
11705 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
11708 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
11709 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
11710 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
11711 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
11712 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
11713 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
11714 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
11715 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
11719 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
11721 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
11723 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11724 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11725 often defined on groups of types.
11727 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
11732 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
11733 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
11736 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
11737 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
11740 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
11743 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
11748 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
11749 in order of increasing precedence:
11753 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
11754 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
11755 expression being the last expression evaluated.
11758 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
11759 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
11762 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
11763 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
11764 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
11765 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
11766 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
11769 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
11770 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
11774 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11777 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11780 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11783 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11786 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11789 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
11790 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
11792 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
11793 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
11794 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
11795 and non-zero for true.
11798 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
11801 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11804 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
11807 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
11808 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
11809 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
11813 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
11814 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
11815 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
11816 operation takes place.
11819 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
11823 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
11825 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
11826 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
11827 to examine the address
11828 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
11832 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
11833 precedence as @code{++}.
11836 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11840 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11845 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
11846 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
11847 pointer based on the stored type information.
11848 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
11851 Dereferences of pointers to members.
11854 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
11855 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11858 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11861 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
11862 and @code{class} types.
11865 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
11866 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
11870 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
11871 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
11872 predefined meaning.
11875 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
11877 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
11879 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
11884 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
11885 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
11886 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
11887 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
11891 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
11892 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
11893 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
11894 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
11895 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
11896 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
11897 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
11898 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
11899 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
11903 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
11904 integral equivalents.
11907 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
11908 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
11909 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
11910 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
11911 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
11912 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
11913 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
11914 @samp{\n} for newline.
11917 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
11918 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
11919 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
11920 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
11924 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
11925 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
11928 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
11929 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
11930 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
11931 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
11934 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
11935 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
11937 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
11938 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
11940 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
11941 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
11942 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
11943 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
11945 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
11946 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
11947 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
11948 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
11949 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
11950 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
11951 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
11952 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
11953 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
11959 @cindex member functions
11961 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
11964 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
11967 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
11968 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
11970 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
11971 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
11972 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
11973 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
11975 @cindex call overloaded functions
11976 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
11977 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
11979 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
11980 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
11981 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
11982 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
11983 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
11986 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
11987 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
11988 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
11989 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
11990 number of function arguments.
11992 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
11993 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
11994 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
11996 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
11997 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
11999 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
12002 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
12003 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
12005 @cindex reference declarations
12007 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
12008 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
12011 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
12012 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
12013 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
12014 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
12015 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
12018 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
12019 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
12020 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
12021 necessary, for example in an expression like
12022 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
12023 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
12024 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
12027 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
12028 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
12029 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
12030 invoking user-defined operators.
12033 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
12035 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
12037 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
12038 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
12039 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12040 selects the working language.
12042 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
12043 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
12044 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
12045 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
12046 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
12047 for further details.
12049 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
12050 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
12051 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
12054 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
12056 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
12058 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
12059 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
12060 considers two variables type equivalent if:
12064 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
12068 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
12069 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
12072 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
12075 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
12076 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
12081 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
12082 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
12083 that is not itself an array.
12086 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
12088 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
12089 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
12090 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
12091 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
12093 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
12094 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
12097 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
12098 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
12100 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
12102 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
12103 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
12106 @cindex break in overloaded functions
12107 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
12108 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
12109 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
12110 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
12111 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
12113 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
12114 @item rbreak @var{regex}
12115 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
12116 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
12118 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12120 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
12123 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
12124 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
12126 @cindex inheritance
12127 @item ptype @var{typename}
12128 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
12130 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
12132 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
12133 @item set print demangle
12134 @itemx show print demangle
12135 @itemx set print asm-demangle
12136 @itemx show print asm-demangle
12137 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
12138 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
12139 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12141 @item set print object
12142 @itemx show print object
12143 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
12144 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12146 @item set print vtbl
12147 @itemx show print vtbl
12148 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
12149 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12150 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
12151 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
12153 @kindex set overload-resolution
12154 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
12155 @item set overload-resolution on
12156 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
12157 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
12158 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
12159 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
12160 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
12161 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
12163 @item set overload-resolution off
12164 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
12165 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12166 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
12167 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
12168 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12169 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
12172 @kindex show overload-resolution
12173 @item show overload-resolution
12174 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
12176 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
12177 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
12178 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
12179 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
12180 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
12181 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
12182 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
12185 @node Decimal Floating Point
12186 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
12187 @cindex decimal floating point format
12189 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
12190 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
12191 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
12192 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
12194 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
12195 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
12196 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
12199 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
12200 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
12201 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
12203 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
12204 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
12205 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
12207 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
12208 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
12209 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
12215 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
12216 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
12217 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
12220 @subsection Objective-C
12222 @cindex Objective-C
12223 This section provides information about some commands and command
12224 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
12225 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
12226 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
12229 * Method Names in Commands::
12230 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
12233 @node Method Names in Commands
12234 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
12236 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
12237 names as line specifications:
12239 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
12240 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
12241 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
12242 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
12243 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
12247 @item @code{info line}
12252 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
12255 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
12258 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
12259 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
12260 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
12261 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
12262 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
12263 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
12267 break -[Fruit create]
12270 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
12274 list +[NSText initialize]
12277 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
12278 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
12279 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
12280 is also possible to specify just a method name:
12286 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
12287 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
12288 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
12289 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
12292 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
12293 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
12296 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
12299 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
12300 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
12301 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
12302 @kindex print-object
12303 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
12305 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
12308 print -[@var{object} hash]
12311 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
12312 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
12314 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
12315 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
12316 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
12317 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
12318 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
12319 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
12322 @subsection OpenCL C
12325 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
12328 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
12329 * OpenCL C Expressions::
12330 * OpenCL C Operators::
12333 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
12334 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
12336 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
12337 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
12338 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
12339 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
12340 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
12342 @node OpenCL C Expressions
12343 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
12345 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
12346 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
12347 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
12348 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
12350 @node OpenCL C Operators
12351 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
12353 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
12354 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
12358 @subsection Fortran
12359 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
12361 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
12362 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
12364 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
12365 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
12366 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
12367 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
12368 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
12372 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
12373 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
12374 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
12377 @node Fortran Operators
12378 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
12380 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
12382 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12383 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
12384 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
12388 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
12392 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
12393 represent a section of array.
12396 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
12397 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
12398 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
12402 @node Fortran Defaults
12403 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
12405 @cindex Fortran Defaults
12407 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
12408 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
12409 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
12410 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
12412 @node Special Fortran Commands
12413 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
12415 @cindex Special Fortran commands
12417 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
12418 such as displaying common blocks.
12421 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
12422 @kindex info common
12423 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
12424 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
12425 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
12426 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
12433 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
12434 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
12435 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
12436 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
12439 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
12440 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
12441 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
12444 @subsection Modula-2
12446 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
12448 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
12449 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
12450 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
12451 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
12452 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
12455 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
12457 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
12458 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
12459 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
12460 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
12461 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
12462 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
12463 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
12464 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12465 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
12469 @subsubsection Operators
12470 @cindex Modula-2 operators
12472 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12473 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
12474 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
12475 following definitions hold:
12480 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
12484 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
12487 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
12490 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
12494 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
12497 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
12500 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
12504 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
12505 increasing precedence:
12509 Function argument or array index separator.
12512 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
12516 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
12520 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
12521 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
12522 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
12524 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
12525 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
12526 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
12527 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
12531 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
12532 Same precedence as @code{<}.
12535 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
12538 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
12541 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
12544 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
12545 and difference on set types.
12548 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
12552 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
12553 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
12556 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
12557 precedence as @code{*}.
12560 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
12563 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
12566 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
12570 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
12571 precedence as @code{^}.
12574 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
12577 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
12581 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
12585 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
12586 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
12587 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
12588 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
12592 @node Built-In Func/Proc
12593 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
12594 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
12596 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
12597 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
12602 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
12605 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
12608 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
12611 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
12612 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
12613 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
12616 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
12619 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
12625 represents a variable.
12628 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
12629 explanation of the function for details.
12632 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
12636 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
12639 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
12640 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
12643 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12646 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12648 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
12649 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12652 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12653 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
12656 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
12657 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
12659 @item HIGH(@var{a})
12660 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
12663 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12665 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
12666 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12669 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12670 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
12671 there. Returns the new set.
12674 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
12677 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
12680 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
12683 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
12684 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
12685 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
12686 integral, character and enumerated types.
12688 @item SIZE(@var{x})
12689 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12691 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
12692 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
12694 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
12695 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12697 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
12698 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12702 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
12703 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
12707 @cindex Modula-2 constants
12709 @subsubsection Constants
12711 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
12717 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
12718 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
12719 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
12720 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
12723 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
12724 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
12725 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
12726 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
12727 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
12731 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
12732 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
12733 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
12734 followed by a @samp{C}.
12737 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
12738 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
12739 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
12740 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
12744 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
12747 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
12751 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
12754 Set constants are not yet supported.
12758 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
12759 @cindex Modula-2 types
12761 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
12762 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
12763 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
12764 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
12765 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
12766 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
12768 The first example contains the following section of code:
12777 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
12778 @code{r} and @code{s}.
12781 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12783 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12785 (@value{GDBP}) print r
12787 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
12792 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
12796 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
12800 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
12803 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12804 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
12808 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
12809 expressions using the debugger.
12811 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
12812 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
12816 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
12820 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12821 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
12824 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
12825 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
12826 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
12829 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
12833 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
12834 t = [blue..yellow] ;
12842 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
12843 and value of a variable.
12846 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12848 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
12849 type = [blue..yellow]
12853 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
12854 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
12855 their @code{C} counterparts.
12859 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12865 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12866 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
12867 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12868 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12871 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
12872 pointer types as shown in this example:
12876 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12883 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
12886 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12887 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12890 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
12891 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
12902 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
12903 myrange = [-2..2] ;
12905 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
12909 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
12913 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12914 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
12917 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
12922 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
12923 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
12925 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
12926 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
12927 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12928 selected the working language.
12930 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
12931 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
12932 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
12933 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
12936 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
12937 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
12939 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
12940 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
12944 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
12945 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
12946 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
12947 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
12948 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
12949 returned a pointer.)
12952 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
12953 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
12954 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
12955 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
12958 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
12962 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
12966 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
12967 @cindex Modula-2 checks
12970 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
12973 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
12975 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
12979 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
12980 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
12983 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
12984 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
12987 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
12988 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
12990 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
12991 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
12994 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12996 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
12997 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
12999 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
13000 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
13003 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
13006 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
13007 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
13012 @var{module} . @var{id}
13013 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
13017 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
13018 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
13019 identifier within your program, except another module.
13021 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
13022 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
13023 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
13024 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
13026 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
13027 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
13028 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
13029 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
13030 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
13034 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
13036 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
13037 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
13038 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
13039 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
13040 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
13041 analogue in Modula-2.
13043 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
13044 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
13045 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
13046 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
13047 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
13048 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
13050 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
13051 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
13052 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
13058 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
13059 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
13060 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
13061 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
13065 @cindex expressions in Ada
13067 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
13068 and semantics supported by Ada mode
13070 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
13071 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
13072 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
13073 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
13074 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13075 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
13077 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
13080 @node Ada Mode Intro
13081 @subsubsection Introduction
13082 @cindex Ada mode, general
13084 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
13085 syntax, with some extensions.
13086 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
13090 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
13091 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
13092 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
13093 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
13096 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
13097 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13100 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13103 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
13104 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
13105 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
13106 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
13107 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
13109 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
13110 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
13111 was translated from an Ada source file.
13113 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
13114 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
13115 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
13116 middle (to allow based literals).
13118 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
13119 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
13120 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
13121 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
13122 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
13123 functions to procedures elsewhere.
13125 @node Omissions from Ada
13126 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
13127 @cindex Ada, omissions from
13129 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
13133 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
13137 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
13138 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
13141 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
13144 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
13150 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
13151 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
13154 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
13155 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
13163 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
13164 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
13165 not currently available.
13168 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
13169 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
13170 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
13171 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
13172 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
13173 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
13174 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
13175 indeterminate values.
13178 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
13179 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
13180 are not implemented.
13183 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
13184 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
13185 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
13186 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
13187 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
13190 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
13191 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
13192 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
13193 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
13194 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
13195 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
13199 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
13200 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
13201 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
13202 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
13203 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
13204 declared to have a type such as:
13207 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
13209 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
13213 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
13217 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
13218 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
13221 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
13222 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
13223 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
13224 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
13225 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
13226 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
13227 redundant component associations, although which component values are
13228 assigned in such cases is not defined.
13231 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
13234 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
13235 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
13236 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
13237 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
13238 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
13239 the proper resolution.
13242 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
13245 Entry calls are not implemented.
13248 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
13249 formats are not supported.
13252 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
13255 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
13256 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
13258 Should your program
13259 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
13260 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
13263 @node Additions to Ada
13264 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
13265 @cindex Ada, deviations from
13267 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
13268 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
13272 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
13273 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
13274 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
13275 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
13276 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
13277 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
13278 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
13279 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
13282 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
13283 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
13284 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
13287 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
13288 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
13291 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
13292 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
13295 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
13296 additions specific to Ada:
13300 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
13301 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
13304 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
13305 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
13309 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
13310 the value of its right-hand operand.
13311 This allows, for example,
13312 complex conditional breaks:
13315 (@value{GDBP}) break f
13316 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
13320 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
13321 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
13322 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
13323 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
13324 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
13325 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
13326 in strings. For example,
13328 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
13331 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
13335 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
13336 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
13340 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
13344 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
13345 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
13346 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
13347 of 3 might print as
13354 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
13358 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
13359 multi-character subsequence of
13360 their names (an exact match gets preference).
13361 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
13362 in place of @t{a'length}.
13365 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
13366 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
13367 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
13368 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
13369 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
13370 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
13373 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
13377 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
13378 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
13379 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
13380 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
13385 @node Stopping Before Main Program
13386 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
13388 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
13389 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
13390 before reaching the main procedure.
13391 As defined in the Ada Reference
13392 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
13393 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
13394 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
13395 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
13398 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
13399 @cindex Ada, tasking
13401 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
13402 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
13407 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
13414 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13415 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13416 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13417 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
13418 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
13419 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
13424 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
13425 task currently being inspected.
13429 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
13435 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
13438 The base priority of the task.
13441 Current state of the task.
13445 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
13449 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
13450 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
13453 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
13454 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
13455 terminated themselves.
13457 @item Child Activation Wait
13458 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
13460 @item Accept Statement
13461 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
13463 @item Waiting on entry call
13464 The task is waiting on an entry call.
13466 @item Async Select Wait
13467 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
13471 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
13474 @item Child Termination Wait
13475 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
13476 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
13477 waiting on a terminate Phase.
13479 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
13480 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
13481 finish terminating.
13483 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
13484 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
13488 Name of the task in the program.
13492 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
13493 @item info task @var{taskno}
13494 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
13495 the following example:
13500 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13501 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13502 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13503 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
13504 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
13505 Ada Task: 0x807c468
13508 Parent: 1 (main_task)
13514 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
13515 @cindex current Ada task ID
13516 This command prints the ID of the current task.
13522 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13523 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13524 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13525 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
13526 (@value{GDBP}) task
13527 [Current task is 2]
13530 @item task @var{taskno}
13531 @cindex Ada task switching
13532 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
13533 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
13534 from the current task to the given task.
13540 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13541 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13542 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13543 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
13544 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
13545 [Switching to task 1]
13546 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
13548 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
13549 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
13550 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
13551 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
13552 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
13555 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
13556 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
13557 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
13558 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
13559 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
13560 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
13561 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
13562 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
13563 in @ref{Specify Location}.
13565 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
13566 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
13567 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
13568 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
13569 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
13571 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
13572 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
13575 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
13576 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
13577 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
13585 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13586 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13587 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13588 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
13589 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13590 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
13591 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
13592 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
13593 (@value{GDBP}) cont
13598 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
13600 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13601 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13602 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13603 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
13604 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13605 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
13609 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
13610 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13611 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
13613 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
13614 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
13615 the platform being used.
13616 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
13617 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
13620 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
13621 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
13622 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
13623 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
13624 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
13625 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
13627 @node Ravenscar Profile
13628 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
13629 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
13631 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
13632 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
13636 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
13637 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
13638 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
13639 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
13640 Profile. This is the default.
13642 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
13643 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
13644 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
13645 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
13646 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
13647 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
13648 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
13650 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
13651 @item show ravenscar task-switching
13652 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
13653 using the Ravenscar Profile.
13658 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
13659 @cindex Ada, problems
13661 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
13662 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
13664 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
13665 and the GNU Ada compiler.
13669 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
13670 storage are invisible to the debugger.
13673 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
13674 argument lists are treated as positional).
13677 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
13680 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
13681 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
13685 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
13686 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
13687 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
13688 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
13689 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
13690 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
13691 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
13692 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
13693 you can usually resolve the confusion
13694 by qualifying the problematic names with package
13695 @code{Standard} explicitly.
13698 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
13699 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
13700 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
13701 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
13702 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
13705 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13706 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13709 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
13710 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
13711 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
13712 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
13713 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
13714 This is the default.
13716 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
13717 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
13718 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
13719 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
13720 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
13721 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
13722 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
13726 @node Unsupported Languages
13727 @section Unsupported Languages
13729 @cindex unsupported languages
13730 @cindex minimal language
13731 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
13732 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
13733 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
13734 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
13735 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
13736 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
13738 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
13739 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
13743 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
13745 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
13746 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
13747 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
13748 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
13749 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
13750 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
13751 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13753 @cindex symbol names
13754 @cindex names of symbols
13755 @cindex quoting names
13756 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
13757 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
13758 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
13759 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
13760 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
13761 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
13762 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
13763 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
13770 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
13773 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
13774 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
13775 @kindex set case-sensitive
13776 @item set case-sensitive on
13777 @itemx set case-sensitive off
13778 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
13779 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
13780 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
13781 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
13782 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
13783 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
13784 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
13785 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
13786 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
13787 case-insensitive matches.
13789 @kindex show case-sensitive
13790 @item show case-sensitive
13791 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
13794 @kindex info address
13795 @cindex address of a symbol
13796 @item info address @var{symbol}
13797 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
13798 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
13799 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
13802 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
13803 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
13804 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
13806 @kindex info symbol
13807 @cindex symbol from address
13808 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
13809 @item info symbol @var{addr}
13810 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
13811 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
13812 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
13815 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
13816 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
13820 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
13821 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
13823 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
13824 library containing the symbol is also printed:
13827 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
13828 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
13829 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
13830 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
13834 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
13835 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
13836 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
13837 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
13838 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
13839 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
13840 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
13841 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
13842 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
13843 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
13844 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13847 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
13848 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
13849 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
13850 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13852 For example, for this variable declaration:
13855 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
13859 the two commands give this output:
13863 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
13864 type = struct complex
13865 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
13866 type = struct complex @{
13874 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
13875 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
13877 @cindex incomplete type
13878 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
13879 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
13880 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
13881 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
13882 given these declarations:
13886 struct foo *fooptr;
13890 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
13893 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
13894 $1 = <incomplete type>
13898 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
13899 completely specified.
13902 @item info types @var{regexp}
13904 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
13905 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
13906 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
13907 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
13908 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
13909 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
13910 name is @code{value}.
13912 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
13913 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
13914 lists all source files where a type is defined.
13917 @cindex local variables
13918 @item info scope @var{location}
13919 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
13920 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
13921 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
13922 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
13923 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
13926 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
13927 Scope for command_line_handler:
13928 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
13929 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
13930 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
13931 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
13932 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
13933 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
13934 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
13938 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
13939 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
13942 @kindex info source
13944 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
13945 the function containing the current point of execution:
13948 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
13950 the directory it was compiled in,
13952 its length, in lines,
13954 which programming language it is written in,
13956 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
13957 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
13959 whether the debugging information includes information about
13960 preprocessor macros.
13964 @kindex info sources
13966 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
13967 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
13968 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
13970 @kindex info functions
13971 @item info functions
13972 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
13974 @item info functions @var{regexp}
13975 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
13976 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
13977 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
13978 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
13979 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
13980 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
13981 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
13983 @kindex info variables
13984 @item info variables
13985 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
13986 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
13988 @item info variables @var{regexp}
13989 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
13990 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
13993 @kindex info classes
13994 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
13996 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
13997 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
13998 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
14001 @kindex info selectors
14002 @item info selectors
14003 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
14004 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
14005 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
14009 This was never implemented.
14010 @kindex info methods
14012 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
14013 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
14014 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
14015 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
14016 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
14017 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
14018 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
14019 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
14022 @cindex reloading symbols
14023 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
14024 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
14025 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
14026 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
14027 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
14030 @kindex set symbol-reloading
14031 @item set symbol-reloading on
14032 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
14033 object file with a particular name is seen again.
14035 @item set symbol-reloading off
14036 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
14037 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
14038 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
14039 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
14040 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
14041 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
14044 @kindex show symbol-reloading
14045 @item show symbol-reloading
14046 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
14049 @cindex opaque data types
14050 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
14051 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
14052 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
14053 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
14054 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
14055 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
14056 another source file. The default is on.
14058 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
14059 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
14061 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
14062 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
14063 is printed as follows:
14065 @{<no data fields>@}
14068 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
14069 @item show opaque-type-resolution
14070 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
14072 @kindex maint print symbols
14073 @cindex symbol dump
14074 @kindex maint print psymbols
14075 @cindex partial symbol dump
14076 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
14077 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
14078 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
14079 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
14080 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
14081 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
14082 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
14083 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
14084 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
14085 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
14086 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
14087 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
14088 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
14089 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
14090 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
14091 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
14092 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
14094 @kindex maint info symtabs
14095 @kindex maint info psymtabs
14096 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
14097 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14098 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14099 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14100 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14101 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14103 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
14104 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
14105 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
14106 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
14107 structure in more detail. For example:
14110 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
14111 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14112 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14113 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14114 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
14117 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
14118 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
14119 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
14120 dependencies (none)
14123 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14127 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
14128 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
14129 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
14130 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
14131 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
14134 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
14135 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
14137 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14138 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14139 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14140 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14141 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
14144 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
14145 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
14146 debugformat DWARF 2
14155 @chapter Altering Execution
14157 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
14158 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
14159 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
14160 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
14163 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
14164 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
14165 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
14168 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
14169 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
14170 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
14171 * Returning:: Returning from a function
14172 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
14173 * Patching:: Patching your program
14177 @section Assignment to Variables
14180 @cindex setting variables
14181 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
14182 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
14189 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
14190 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
14191 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
14192 information on operators in supported languages.
14194 @kindex set variable
14195 @cindex variables, setting
14196 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
14197 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
14198 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
14199 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
14200 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
14202 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
14203 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
14204 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
14205 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
14206 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
14207 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
14208 command @code{set width}:
14211 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
14213 (@value{GDBP}) p width
14215 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
14216 Invalid syntax in expression.
14220 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
14221 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
14224 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
14227 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
14228 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
14229 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
14230 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
14231 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
14232 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
14236 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
14240 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
14244 The program being debugged has been started already.
14245 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
14246 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
14247 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
14248 Invalid bfd target.
14249 (@value{GDBP}) show g
14250 The current BFD target is "=4".
14255 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
14256 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
14260 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
14263 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
14264 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
14265 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
14266 same length or shorter.
14267 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
14268 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
14270 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
14271 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
14272 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
14273 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
14274 and representation in memory), and
14277 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
14281 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
14284 @section Continuing at a Different Address
14286 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
14287 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
14288 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
14292 @item jump @var{linespec}
14293 @itemx jump @var{location}
14294 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
14295 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
14296 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
14297 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
14298 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
14299 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14301 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
14302 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
14303 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
14304 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
14305 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
14306 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
14307 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
14308 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
14309 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
14312 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
14313 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
14314 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
14315 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
14316 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
14324 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
14325 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
14326 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
14328 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
14329 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
14330 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
14335 @section Giving your Program a Signal
14336 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
14340 @item signal @var{signal}
14341 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
14342 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
14343 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
14344 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
14346 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
14347 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
14348 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
14349 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
14352 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
14353 after executing the command.
14357 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
14358 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
14359 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
14360 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
14361 passes the signal directly to your program.
14365 @section Returning from a Function
14368 @cindex returning from a function
14371 @itemx return @var{expression}
14372 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
14373 command. If you give an
14374 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
14378 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
14379 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
14380 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
14381 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
14383 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
14384 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
14385 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
14386 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
14389 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
14390 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
14391 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
14392 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
14393 selected stack frame returns naturally.
14395 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
14396 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
14397 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
14398 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
14399 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
14400 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
14401 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
14402 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
14403 assignment into the right register(s).
14405 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
14406 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
14407 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
14408 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
14409 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
14410 into a @code{long long int}:
14413 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
14415 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14416 Make func return now? (y or n) y
14417 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
14418 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
14422 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
14423 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
14424 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
14425 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
14426 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
14427 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
14428 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
14429 an appropriate cast explicitly:
14432 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
14433 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14434 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
14435 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
14436 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
14437 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
14438 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
14443 @section Calling Program Functions
14446 @cindex calling functions
14447 @cindex inferior functions, calling
14448 @item print @var{expr}
14449 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
14450 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
14454 @item call @var{expr}
14455 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
14458 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
14459 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
14460 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
14461 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
14462 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
14466 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
14467 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
14468 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
14469 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
14471 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
14472 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
14473 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
14474 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
14475 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
14476 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
14477 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
14478 in that case is controlled by the
14479 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
14482 @item set unwindonsignal
14483 @kindex set unwindonsignal
14484 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
14485 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
14486 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
14487 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
14488 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
14489 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
14490 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
14493 @item show unwindonsignal
14494 @kindex show unwindonsignal
14495 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
14498 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
14499 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
14500 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
14501 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
14502 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
14503 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
14504 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
14505 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
14506 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
14507 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
14509 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
14510 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
14511 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
14516 @cindex weak alias functions
14517 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
14518 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
14519 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
14520 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
14521 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
14522 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
14526 @section Patching Programs
14528 @cindex patching binaries
14529 @cindex writing into executables
14530 @cindex writing into corefiles
14532 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
14533 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
14534 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
14535 patching your program's binary.
14537 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
14538 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
14539 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
14545 @itemx set write off
14546 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
14547 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
14548 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
14550 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
14551 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
14552 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
14556 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
14557 as well as reading.
14561 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
14563 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
14564 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
14565 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
14566 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
14569 * Files:: Commands to specify files
14570 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
14571 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
14572 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
14573 * Data Files:: GDB data files
14577 @section Commands to Specify Files
14579 @cindex symbol table
14580 @cindex core dump file
14582 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
14583 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
14584 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
14585 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
14587 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
14588 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
14589 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
14590 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
14591 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
14592 new files are useful.
14595 @cindex executable file
14597 @item file @var{filename}
14598 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
14599 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
14600 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
14601 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
14602 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
14603 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
14604 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
14605 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
14607 @cindex unlinked object files
14608 @cindex patching object files
14609 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
14610 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
14611 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
14612 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
14613 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
14614 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
14615 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
14616 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
14619 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
14620 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
14623 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14624 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
14625 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
14626 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
14627 discard information on the executable file.
14629 @kindex symbol-file
14630 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14631 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
14632 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
14633 table and program to run from the same file.
14635 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
14636 program's symbol table.
14638 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
14639 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
14640 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
14641 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
14644 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
14647 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
14648 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
14649 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
14650 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
14651 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
14652 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
14655 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
14656 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
14657 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
14658 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
14659 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
14661 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
14662 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
14663 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
14664 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
14665 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
14666 Warnings and Messages}.)
14668 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
14669 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
14670 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
14671 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
14675 @cindex reading symbols immediately
14676 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
14677 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14678 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14679 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
14680 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
14681 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
14682 entire symbol table available.
14684 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
14685 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
14686 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
14687 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
14688 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
14689 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
14693 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
14695 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
14696 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
14697 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
14698 executable file itself for other parts.
14700 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
14703 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
14704 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
14705 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
14706 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
14707 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
14709 @kindex add-symbol-file
14710 @cindex dynamic linking
14711 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
14712 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
14713 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
14714 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
14715 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
14716 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
14717 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
14718 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
14719 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
14720 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
14721 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
14722 @var{address} as an expression.
14724 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
14725 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
14726 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
14727 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
14728 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
14730 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
14731 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
14732 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
14733 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
14734 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
14735 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
14736 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
14737 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
14738 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
14742 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
14743 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
14745 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
14746 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
14748 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
14749 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
14753 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
14754 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
14755 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
14756 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
14757 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
14758 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
14759 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
14760 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
14761 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
14764 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
14766 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
14767 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
14768 @cindex load symbols from memory
14769 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
14770 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
14771 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
14772 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
14773 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
14774 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
14775 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
14776 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
14777 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
14779 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
14781 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
14782 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
14783 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
14784 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
14785 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
14786 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
14787 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
14788 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
14789 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
14790 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
14793 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
14794 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
14795 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
14796 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
14797 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
14798 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
14799 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
14803 @kindex info target
14806 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
14807 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
14808 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
14809 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
14810 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
14813 @kindex maint info sections
14814 @item maint info sections
14815 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
14816 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
14817 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
14818 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
14819 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
14820 may be arbitrarily combined):
14824 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
14825 @item @var{sections}
14826 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
14827 @item @var{section-flags}
14828 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
14829 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
14832 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
14833 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
14835 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
14836 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
14838 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
14840 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
14842 Section contains executable code only.
14844 Section contains data only (no executable code).
14846 Section will reside in ROM.
14848 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
14850 Section is not empty.
14852 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
14853 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
14854 A notification to the linker that the section contains
14855 COFF shared library information.
14857 Section contains common symbols.
14860 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
14861 @cindex read-only sections
14862 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
14863 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
14864 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
14865 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
14866 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
14867 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
14868 enhancement to debugging performance.
14870 The default is off.
14872 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
14873 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
14874 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
14875 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
14877 @item show trust-readonly-sections
14878 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
14881 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
14882 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
14883 name and remembers it that way.
14885 @cindex shared libraries
14886 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
14887 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
14888 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
14890 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
14891 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
14893 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
14894 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
14895 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
14896 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
14897 debugging a core file).
14899 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
14900 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
14902 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
14903 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
14904 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
14906 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
14907 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
14908 particularly large or there are many of them.
14910 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
14914 @kindex set auto-solib-add
14915 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
14916 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
14917 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
14918 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
14919 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
14920 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
14921 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
14923 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
14924 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
14925 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
14926 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
14927 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
14928 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
14929 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
14930 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
14931 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
14933 @kindex show auto-solib-add
14934 @item show auto-solib-add
14935 Display the current autoloading mode.
14938 @cindex load shared library
14939 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
14943 @kindex info sharedlibrary
14945 @item info share @var{regex}
14946 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14947 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
14948 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
14949 all shared libraries that are loaded.
14951 @kindex sharedlibrary
14953 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14954 @itemx share @var{regex}
14955 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
14956 Unix regular expression.
14957 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
14958 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
14959 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
14962 @item nosharedlibrary
14963 @kindex nosharedlibrary
14964 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
14965 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
14966 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
14967 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
14971 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
14972 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
14973 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
14976 @item set stop-on-solib-events
14977 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
14978 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
14979 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
14980 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
14983 @item show stop-on-solib-events
14984 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
14985 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
14986 library events happen.
14989 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
14990 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
14991 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
14992 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
14993 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
14994 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
14995 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
14998 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
14999 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
15000 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
15001 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
15002 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
15005 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
15006 @cindex system root, alternate
15007 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
15008 @kindex set sysroot
15009 @item set sysroot @var{path}
15010 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
15011 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
15012 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
15013 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
15014 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
15015 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
15018 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
15019 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
15020 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
15021 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
15022 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
15023 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
15024 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
15025 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
15026 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
15028 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
15029 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
15030 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
15031 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
15032 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
15035 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
15038 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
15039 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
15043 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
15046 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
15047 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
15048 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
15052 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
15055 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
15056 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
15057 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
15061 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
15062 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15063 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15067 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
15068 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
15069 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
15071 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
15072 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
15075 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
15078 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
15079 if you don't want or need to.
15081 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
15084 @cindex default system root
15085 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
15086 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
15087 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
15088 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15089 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
15090 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15093 @kindex show sysroot
15095 Display the current shared library prefix.
15097 @kindex set solib-search-path
15098 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
15099 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
15100 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
15101 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
15102 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
15103 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
15104 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
15105 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
15106 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
15107 of shared library symbols.
15109 @kindex show solib-search-path
15110 @item show solib-search-path
15111 Display the current shared library search path.
15113 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
15114 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
15115 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
15116 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
15117 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
15119 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
15120 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
15121 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
15122 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
15123 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
15124 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
15125 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
15126 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
15127 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
15128 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
15129 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
15130 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
15131 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
15132 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
15133 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
15134 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
15135 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
15136 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
15137 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
15138 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
15139 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
15140 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
15144 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
15145 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
15146 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
15150 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
15151 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
15152 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
15153 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
15154 considered directory separators.
15157 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
15158 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
15159 This is the default.
15164 @node Separate Debug Files
15165 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
15166 @cindex separate debugging information files
15167 @cindex debugging information in separate files
15168 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
15169 @cindex debugging information directory, global
15170 @cindex global debugging information directory
15171 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
15172 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
15174 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
15175 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
15176 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
15177 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
15178 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
15179 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
15180 install only when they need to debug a problem.
15182 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
15187 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
15188 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
15189 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
15190 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
15191 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
15192 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
15193 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
15194 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
15197 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
15198 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
15199 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
15200 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
15201 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
15202 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
15203 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
15204 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
15208 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
15209 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
15213 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
15214 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
15215 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
15216 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
15217 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
15220 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
15221 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
15222 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
15223 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
15224 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
15225 hex characters, not 10.)
15228 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
15229 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
15230 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
15231 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
15232 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
15233 debug information files, in the indicated order:
15237 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
15239 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
15241 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
15243 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
15246 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
15247 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
15251 @kindex set debug-file-directory
15252 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
15253 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15254 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple directory components can be set
15255 concatenating them by a directory separator.
15257 @kindex show debug-file-directory
15258 @item show debug-file-directory
15259 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15264 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
15265 @cindex debug link sections
15266 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
15267 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
15271 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
15274 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
15275 boundary within the section, and
15277 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
15278 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
15279 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
15280 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
15283 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
15284 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
15287 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
15288 @cindex build ID sections
15289 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
15290 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
15291 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
15292 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
15293 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
15294 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
15295 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
15296 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
15297 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
15299 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
15300 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
15301 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
15302 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
15303 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
15304 in an ordinary executable.
15306 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
15307 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
15308 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
15309 following commands:
15312 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
15317 These commands remove the debugging
15318 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
15319 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
15324 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
15325 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
15328 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
15331 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
15332 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
15333 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
15334 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
15337 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
15338 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
15339 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
15340 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
15345 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
15346 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
15347 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
15349 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
15350 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
15351 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
15356 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
15357 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
15363 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
15364 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
15368 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
15369 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
15370 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
15371 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
15374 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
15375 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
15376 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
15377 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
15378 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
15379 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
15381 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
15382 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
15383 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
15384 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
15387 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
15390 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
15391 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
15393 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
15395 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
15396 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
15397 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
15398 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
15399 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
15400 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
15401 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
15402 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
15403 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
15404 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
15405 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
15406 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
15407 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
15408 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
15409 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
15410 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
15411 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
15412 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
15413 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
15414 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
15415 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
15416 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
15417 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
15418 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
15419 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
15420 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
15421 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
15422 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
15423 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
15424 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
15425 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
15426 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
15427 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
15428 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
15429 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
15430 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
15431 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
15432 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
15433 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
15434 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
15435 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
15436 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
15437 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
15438 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
15439 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
15440 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
15441 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
15442 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
15443 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
15444 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
15445 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
15448 unsigned char *end;
15450 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15451 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
15452 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
15453 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15458 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
15462 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
15463 @cindex index files
15464 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
15466 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
15467 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
15468 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
15469 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
15470 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
15473 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
15474 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
15475 using @command{objcopy}.
15477 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
15480 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
15481 @kindex save gdb-index
15482 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
15483 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
15484 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
15488 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
15489 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
15492 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
15493 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
15496 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
15497 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
15498 currently work for programs using Ada.
15500 @node Symbol Errors
15501 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
15503 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
15504 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
15505 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
15506 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
15507 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
15508 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
15509 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
15510 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
15511 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
15512 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
15515 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
15518 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
15520 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
15521 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
15522 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
15523 in its outer scope blocks.
15525 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
15526 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
15527 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
15530 @item block at @var{address} out of order
15532 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
15533 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
15536 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
15537 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
15538 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
15539 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
15542 @item bad block start address patched
15544 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
15545 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
15546 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
15548 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
15549 starting on the previous source line.
15551 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
15554 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
15555 larger than the size of the string table.
15557 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
15558 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
15561 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
15563 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
15564 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
15565 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
15567 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
15568 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
15569 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
15570 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
15571 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
15572 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
15574 @item stub type has NULL name
15576 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
15578 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
15579 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
15580 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
15583 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
15585 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
15590 @section GDB Data Files
15592 @cindex prefix for data files
15593 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
15594 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
15596 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
15597 is currently using.
15600 @kindex set data-directory
15601 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
15602 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
15603 to @var{directory}.
15605 @kindex show data-directory
15606 @item show data-directory
15607 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
15610 @cindex default data directory
15611 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
15612 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
15613 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
15614 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15615 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
15616 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15619 The data directory may also be specified with the
15620 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
15621 @xref{Mode Options}.
15624 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
15626 @cindex debugging target
15627 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
15629 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
15630 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
15631 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
15632 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
15633 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
15634 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
15635 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
15636 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
15638 @cindex target architecture
15639 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
15640 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
15641 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
15645 @kindex set architecture
15646 @kindex show architecture
15647 @item set architecture @var{arch}
15648 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
15649 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
15650 supported architectures.
15652 @item show architecture
15653 Show the current target architecture.
15655 @item set processor
15657 @kindex set processor
15658 @kindex show processor
15659 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
15660 and @code{show architecture}.
15664 * Active Targets:: Active targets
15665 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
15666 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
15669 @node Active Targets
15670 @section Active Targets
15672 @cindex stacking targets
15673 @cindex active targets
15674 @cindex multiple targets
15676 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
15677 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
15678 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
15679 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
15680 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
15681 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
15682 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
15683 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
15684 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
15686 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
15687 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
15688 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
15689 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
15691 @node Target Commands
15692 @section Commands for Managing Targets
15695 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
15696 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
15697 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
15698 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
15699 protocol of the target machine.
15701 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
15702 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
15703 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
15705 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
15706 after executing the command.
15708 @kindex help target
15710 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
15711 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
15712 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15714 @item help target @var{name}
15715 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
15718 @kindex set gnutarget
15719 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
15720 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
15721 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
15722 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
15723 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
15724 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
15727 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
15728 you must know the actual BFD name.
15732 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
15734 @kindex show gnutarget
15735 @item show gnutarget
15736 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
15737 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
15738 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
15739 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
15742 @cindex common targets
15743 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
15748 @item target exec @var{program}
15749 @cindex executable file target
15750 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
15751 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
15753 @item target core @var{filename}
15754 @cindex core dump file target
15755 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
15756 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
15758 @item target remote @var{medium}
15759 @cindex remote target
15760 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
15761 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
15762 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
15764 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
15765 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
15768 target remote /dev/ttya
15771 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
15772 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
15773 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
15774 clobbered by the download.
15776 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
15777 @cindex built-in simulator target
15778 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
15786 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
15787 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
15788 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
15789 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
15794 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
15798 @item target nrom @var{dev}
15799 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
15800 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
15804 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
15805 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
15807 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
15808 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
15809 various aspects of this process.
15814 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15815 @cindex hash mark while downloading
15816 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
15817 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
15818 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
15822 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15823 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
15825 @item set debug monitor
15826 @kindex set debug monitor
15827 @cindex display remote monitor communications
15828 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
15829 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15831 @item show debug monitor
15832 @kindex show debug monitor
15833 Show the current status of displaying communications between
15834 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15839 @kindex load @var{filename}
15840 @item load @var{filename}
15842 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
15843 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
15844 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
15845 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
15846 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
15847 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
15849 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
15850 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
15851 target is @dots{}}''
15853 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
15854 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
15855 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
15856 specifies a fixed address.
15857 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
15859 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
15860 load programs into flash memory.
15862 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
15866 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
15868 @cindex choosing target byte order
15869 @cindex target byte order
15871 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
15872 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
15873 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
15874 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
15875 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
15876 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
15880 @item set endian big
15881 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
15883 @item set endian little
15884 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
15886 @item set endian auto
15887 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
15891 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
15895 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
15896 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
15900 @node Remote Debugging
15901 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
15902 @cindex remote debugging
15904 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
15905 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
15906 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
15907 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
15908 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
15910 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
15911 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
15912 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
15913 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
15914 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
15915 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
15917 Other remote targets may be available in your
15918 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
15921 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
15922 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
15923 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
15924 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
15925 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
15929 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
15931 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
15932 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
15933 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
15934 program as the first argument.
15936 @cindex @code{target remote}
15937 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
15938 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
15939 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
15940 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
15941 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
15942 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
15946 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
15947 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
15948 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
15949 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
15952 target remote /dev/ttyb
15955 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
15956 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
15957 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
15958 @code{target} command.
15960 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
15961 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15962 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
15963 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
15964 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
15965 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
15966 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
15967 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
15970 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
15974 target remote manyfarms:2828
15977 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
15978 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
15979 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
15980 port 1234 on your local machine:
15983 target remote :1234
15987 Note that the colon is still required here.
15989 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15990 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
15991 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
15992 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
15995 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
15998 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
15999 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
16000 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
16001 cause havoc with your debugging session.
16003 @item target remote | @var{command}
16004 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
16005 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
16006 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
16007 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
16008 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
16009 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
16010 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
16011 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
16013 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
16014 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
16015 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
16019 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
16020 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
16021 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
16022 need to use @kbd{run}.
16024 @cindex interrupting remote programs
16025 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
16026 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
16027 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
16028 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
16029 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
16030 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
16033 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
16034 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
16037 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
16038 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
16039 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
16040 goes back to waiting.
16043 @kindex detach (remote)
16045 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
16046 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
16047 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
16048 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
16049 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
16053 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
16054 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
16055 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
16056 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
16059 @cindex send command to remote monitor
16060 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
16061 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
16063 @item monitor @var{cmd}
16064 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
16065 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
16066 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
16067 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
16071 @node File Transfer
16072 @section Sending files to a remote system
16073 @cindex remote target, file transfer
16074 @cindex file transfer
16075 @cindex sending files to remote systems
16077 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
16078 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
16079 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
16080 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
16081 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
16082 the only way to upload or download files.
16084 Not all remote targets support these commands.
16088 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
16089 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
16090 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
16093 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
16094 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
16095 on the host system.
16097 @kindex remote delete
16098 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
16099 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
16104 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
16107 @cindex remote connection without stubs
16108 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
16109 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
16110 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
16112 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
16113 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
16114 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
16115 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
16116 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
16117 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
16118 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
16119 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
16120 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
16121 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
16122 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
16123 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
16124 choice for debugging.
16126 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
16127 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
16131 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
16132 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
16133 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
16134 target system with the same privileges as the user running
16138 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
16139 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
16141 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
16142 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
16143 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
16144 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
16145 system does all the symbol handling.
16147 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
16148 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
16152 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
16155 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
16156 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
16157 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
16161 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
16164 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
16167 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
16170 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
16173 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
16174 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
16175 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
16176 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
16177 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
16178 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
16179 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
16180 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
16181 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
16182 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
16183 @code{target remote} command.
16185 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
16187 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
16188 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
16191 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
16194 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
16195 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
16198 @cindex attach to a program by name
16199 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
16200 @code{pidof} utility:
16203 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
16206 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
16207 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
16208 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
16210 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
16211 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
16212 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
16214 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
16215 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
16216 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
16217 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
16219 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
16220 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
16221 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
16222 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
16223 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
16224 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
16225 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
16226 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
16227 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
16229 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
16230 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
16231 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
16232 the program you want to debug.
16234 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
16235 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
16236 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
16238 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
16240 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
16241 status information about the debugging process. The
16242 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
16243 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
16244 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
16246 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
16247 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
16248 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
16249 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
16251 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
16252 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
16253 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
16254 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
16256 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
16257 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
16258 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
16259 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
16261 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
16262 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
16266 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
16269 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
16271 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
16273 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
16274 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
16275 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
16276 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
16278 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
16279 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
16280 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
16281 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
16282 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
16283 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
16286 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
16287 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
16288 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
16289 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
16290 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
16291 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
16292 already on the target.
16294 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
16295 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
16296 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
16298 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
16299 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
16300 Here are the available commands.
16304 List the available monitor commands.
16306 @item monitor set debug 0
16307 @itemx monitor set debug 1
16308 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
16310 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
16311 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
16312 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
16313 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
16315 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
16316 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
16317 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
16318 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
16319 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
16320 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to an empty list.
16323 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
16324 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
16325 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
16326 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
16327 of a multi-process mode debug session.
16331 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16332 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16334 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
16335 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
16337 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
16338 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
16339 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
16340 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
16341 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
16342 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
16343 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
16344 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
16345 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
16346 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
16347 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
16348 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
16350 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
16353 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
16355 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
16356 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
16357 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
16359 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
16361 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
16362 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
16363 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
16364 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
16365 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
16366 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
16368 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
16370 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
16371 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
16372 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
16373 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
16374 command for that. For example:
16377 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
16380 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
16381 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
16384 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
16385 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
16386 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
16387 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
16388 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
16389 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
16390 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
16391 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
16392 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
16393 @code{gdbserver} like so:
16396 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
16399 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
16403 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
16404 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
16405 (@value{GDBP}) b main
16406 (@value{GDBP}) continue
16409 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
16410 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
16411 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
16412 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
16413 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
16416 @node Remote Configuration
16417 @section Remote Configuration
16420 @kindex show remote
16421 This section documents the configuration options available when
16422 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
16423 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
16424 system-call-allowed}.
16427 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
16428 @cindex address size for remote targets
16429 @cindex bits in remote address
16430 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
16431 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
16432 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
16433 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
16435 @item show remoteaddresssize
16436 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
16438 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
16439 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
16440 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
16441 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
16444 @item show remotebaud
16445 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
16447 @item set remotebreak
16448 @cindex interrupt remote programs
16449 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
16450 @anchor{set remotebreak}
16451 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
16452 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
16453 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
16454 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
16455 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
16457 @item show remotebreak
16458 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
16459 interrupt the remote program.
16461 @item set remoteflow on
16462 @itemx set remoteflow off
16463 @kindex set remoteflow
16464 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
16465 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
16467 @item show remoteflow
16468 @kindex show remoteflow
16469 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
16471 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
16472 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
16473 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
16474 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
16477 @item show remotelogbase
16478 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
16481 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
16482 @cindex record serial communications on file
16483 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
16484 default is not to record at all.
16486 @item show remotelogfile.
16487 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
16488 serial communications.
16490 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
16491 @cindex timeout for serial communications
16492 @cindex remote timeout
16493 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
16494 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
16496 @item show remotetimeout
16497 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
16500 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
16501 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
16502 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
16503 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
16504 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
16505 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
16506 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
16507 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
16509 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
16510 @itemx show remote exec-file
16511 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
16512 @cindex executable file, for remote target
16513 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
16514 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
16515 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
16516 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
16518 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
16519 @cindex interrupt remote programs
16520 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
16521 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
16522 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
16523 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
16524 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
16525 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
16526 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
16527 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
16529 @item show interrupt-sequence
16530 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
16531 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
16532 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
16533 also known as Magic SysRq g.
16535 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
16536 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
16537 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
16538 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
16539 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
16540 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
16542 @item show interrupt-on-connect
16543 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
16544 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
16548 @item set tcp auto-retry on
16549 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
16550 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
16551 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
16552 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
16553 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
16554 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
16555 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
16556 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
16558 @item set tcp auto-retry off
16559 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
16561 @item show tcp auto-retry
16562 Show the current auto-retry setting.
16564 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
16565 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
16566 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
16567 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
16568 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
16569 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
16570 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
16573 @item show tcp connect-timeout
16574 Show the current connection timeout setting.
16577 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
16578 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
16579 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
16580 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
16581 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
16582 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
16583 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
16584 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
16585 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
16587 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
16588 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
16589 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
16590 @value{GDBN} developers.
16592 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
16593 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
16596 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
16599 @tab Related Features
16601 @item @code{fetch-register}
16603 @tab @code{info registers}
16605 @item @code{set-register}
16609 @item @code{binary-download}
16611 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
16613 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
16614 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
16615 @tab @code{info auxv}
16617 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
16618 @tab @code{qSymbol}
16619 @tab Detecting multiple threads
16621 @item @code{attach}
16622 @tab @code{vAttach}
16625 @item @code{verbose-resume}
16627 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
16633 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
16637 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
16641 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
16645 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
16649 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
16653 @item @code{target-features}
16654 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
16655 @tab @code{set architecture}
16657 @item @code{library-info}
16658 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
16659 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
16661 @item @code{memory-map}
16662 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
16663 @tab @code{info mem}
16665 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
16666 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
16667 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
16669 @item @code{read-spu-object}
16670 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
16671 @tab @code{info spu}
16673 @item @code{write-spu-object}
16674 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
16675 @tab @code{info spu}
16677 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
16678 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
16679 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
16681 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
16682 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
16683 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
16685 @item @code{threads}
16686 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
16687 @tab @code{info threads}
16689 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
16690 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
16691 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
16693 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
16694 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
16695 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
16697 @item @code{search-memory}
16698 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
16701 @item @code{supported-packets}
16702 @tab @code{qSupported}
16703 @tab Remote communications parameters
16705 @item @code{pass-signals}
16706 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
16707 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
16709 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
16710 @tab @code{vFile:close}
16711 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16713 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
16714 @tab @code{vFile:open}
16715 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16717 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
16718 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
16719 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16721 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
16722 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
16723 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16725 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
16726 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
16727 @tab @code{remote delete}
16729 @item @code{noack-packet}
16730 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
16731 @tab Packet acknowledgment
16733 @item @code{osdata}
16734 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
16735 @tab @code{info os}
16737 @item @code{query-attached}
16738 @tab @code{qAttached}
16739 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
16743 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
16745 @cindex debugging stub, example
16746 @cindex remote stub, example
16747 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
16748 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
16749 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
16750 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
16751 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
16752 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
16753 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
16754 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
16756 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
16757 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
16758 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
16759 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
16764 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
16765 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
16766 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
16769 A C subroutine library to support your program's
16770 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
16773 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
16774 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
16775 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
16779 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
16780 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
16781 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
16785 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
16786 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
16787 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16789 @item On the target,
16790 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
16791 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
16792 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
16794 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
16795 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
16796 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
16799 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
16800 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
16803 @cindex remote serial stub list
16804 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
16809 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
16812 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
16815 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
16816 @cindex Motorola 680x0
16818 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
16821 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
16824 For Renesas SH architectures.
16827 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
16829 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
16831 @item sparcl-stub.c
16832 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
16835 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
16839 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
16840 recently added stubs.
16843 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
16844 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
16845 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
16848 @node Stub Contents
16849 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
16851 @cindex remote serial stub
16852 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
16856 @item set_debug_traps
16857 @findex set_debug_traps
16858 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
16859 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
16860 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
16861 beginning of your program.
16863 @item handle_exception
16864 @findex handle_exception
16865 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
16866 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
16867 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
16868 run when a trap is triggered.
16870 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
16871 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
16872 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
16873 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
16874 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
16875 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
16876 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
16877 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
16878 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
16882 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
16883 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
16884 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
16885 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
16886 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
16887 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
16888 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
16889 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
16890 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
16891 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
16892 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
16894 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
16895 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
16896 start of your debugging session.
16899 @node Bootstrapping
16900 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
16902 @cindex remote stub, support routines
16903 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
16904 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
16905 debugging target machine.
16907 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
16911 @item int getDebugChar()
16912 @findex getDebugChar
16913 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
16914 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
16915 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16917 @item void putDebugChar(int)
16918 @findex putDebugChar
16919 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
16920 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
16921 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16924 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
16925 @cindex interrupting remote targets
16926 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
16927 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
16928 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
16929 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
16930 remote system to stop.
16932 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
16933 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
16934 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
16935 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
16937 Other routines you need to supply are:
16940 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
16941 @findex exceptionHandler
16942 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
16943 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
16944 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
16945 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
16946 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
16947 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
16948 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
16949 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
16950 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
16951 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
16952 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
16953 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
16954 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
16956 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
16957 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
16958 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
16959 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
16960 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
16962 @item void flush_i_cache()
16963 @findex flush_i_cache
16964 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
16965 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
16966 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
16968 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
16969 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
16973 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
16976 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
16978 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
16979 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
16980 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
16981 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
16984 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
16985 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
16986 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
16987 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
16990 @node Debug Session
16991 @subsection Putting it All Together
16993 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
16994 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
16999 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
17000 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
17002 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
17003 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
17007 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
17015 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
17016 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
17019 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
17023 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
17024 function in your program, that function is called when
17025 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
17026 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
17027 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
17030 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
17031 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
17034 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
17035 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
17038 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
17039 @c document that. FIXME.
17040 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
17041 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
17044 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
17045 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
17049 @node Configurations
17050 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
17052 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
17053 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
17054 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
17056 There are three major categories of configurations: native
17057 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
17058 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
17059 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
17060 are quite different from each other.
17065 * Embedded Processors::
17072 This section describes details specific to particular native
17077 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
17078 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
17079 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
17080 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
17081 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
17082 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
17083 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
17089 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
17090 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
17091 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
17094 @node BSD libkvm Interface
17095 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
17098 @cindex kernel memory image
17099 @cindex kernel crash dump
17101 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
17102 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
17103 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
17104 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
17105 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
17106 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
17107 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
17111 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
17114 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
17118 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
17121 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
17127 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
17130 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
17131 modern FreeBSD systems.
17134 @node SVR4 Process Information
17135 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
17137 @cindex examine process image
17138 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
17140 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
17141 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
17142 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
17143 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
17144 proc} is available to report information about the process running
17145 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
17146 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
17147 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
17148 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
17154 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
17155 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
17156 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
17157 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
17158 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
17159 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
17160 executable file's absolute file name.
17162 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
17163 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
17164 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
17165 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
17166 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
17167 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
17169 @item info proc mappings
17170 @cindex memory address space mappings
17171 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
17172 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
17173 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
17174 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
17175 memory access rights to that range.
17177 @item info proc stat
17178 @itemx info proc status
17179 @cindex process detailed status information
17180 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
17181 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
17182 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
17183 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
17184 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
17185 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
17186 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
17188 @item info proc all
17189 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
17190 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
17193 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
17194 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
17195 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
17196 @kindex info proc times
17197 @item info proc times
17198 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
17201 @kindex info proc id
17203 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
17204 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
17207 @item set procfs-trace
17208 @kindex set procfs-trace
17209 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
17210 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
17212 @item show procfs-trace
17213 @kindex show procfs-trace
17214 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
17216 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
17217 @kindex set procfs-file
17218 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
17219 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
17220 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
17223 @item show procfs-file
17224 @kindex show procfs-file
17225 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
17227 @item proc-trace-entry
17228 @itemx proc-trace-exit
17229 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
17230 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
17231 @kindex proc-trace-entry
17232 @kindex proc-trace-exit
17233 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
17234 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
17235 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
17236 from the @code{syscall} interface.
17239 @kindex info pidlist
17240 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
17241 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
17242 processes and all the threads within each process.
17245 @kindex info meminfo
17246 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
17247 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
17251 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
17252 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
17253 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
17254 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
17257 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
17258 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
17259 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
17260 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
17262 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
17263 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
17264 subsection describes those commands.
17269 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
17270 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17273 @cindex MS-DOS system info
17274 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
17275 @item info dos sysinfo
17276 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
17277 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
17278 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
17283 @cindex segment descriptor tables
17284 @cindex descriptor tables display
17286 @itemx info dos ldt
17287 @itemx info dos idt
17288 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
17289 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
17290 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
17291 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
17292 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
17293 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
17296 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
17297 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
17298 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
17299 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
17300 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
17302 @cindex garbled pointers
17303 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
17304 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
17305 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
17306 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
17307 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
17308 debugged program's data segment:
17311 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
17312 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
17316 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
17317 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
17319 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
17321 @itemx info dos pte
17322 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
17323 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
17324 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
17325 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
17326 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
17327 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
17328 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
17329 that is currently in use.
17331 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
17332 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
17333 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
17334 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
17335 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
17336 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
17337 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
17339 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
17340 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
17341 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
17344 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
17346 @cindex physical address from linear address
17347 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
17348 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
17349 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
17350 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
17351 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
17352 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
17353 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
17356 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
17357 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
17358 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
17362 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
17363 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
17364 attributes of that page.
17366 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
17367 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
17368 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
17369 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
17370 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
17371 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
17373 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
17377 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
17378 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
17379 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
17383 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
17384 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
17385 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
17386 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
17387 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
17389 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
17392 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
17393 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
17394 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
17395 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
17398 @kindex set com1base
17399 @kindex set com1irq
17400 @kindex set com2base
17401 @kindex set com2irq
17402 @kindex set com3base
17403 @kindex set com3irq
17404 @kindex set com4base
17405 @kindex set com4irq
17406 @item set com1base @var{addr}
17407 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
17410 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
17411 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
17412 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
17414 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
17415 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
17418 @kindex show com1base
17419 @kindex show com1irq
17420 @kindex show com2base
17421 @kindex show com2irq
17422 @kindex show com3base
17423 @kindex show com3irq
17424 @kindex show com4base
17425 @kindex show com4irq
17426 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
17427 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
17428 lines used by the COM ports.
17431 @kindex info serial
17432 @cindex DOS serial port status
17433 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
17434 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
17435 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
17436 counts of various errors encountered so far.
17440 @node Cygwin Native
17441 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
17442 @cindex MS Windows debugging
17443 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
17444 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
17446 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
17447 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
17449 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
17450 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
17451 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
17452 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
17453 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
17454 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
17455 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
17458 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
17459 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
17460 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
17465 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
17466 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17468 @item info w32 selector
17469 This command displays information returned by
17470 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
17471 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
17472 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
17473 Without argument, this command displays information
17474 about the six segment registers.
17476 @item info w32 thread-information-block
17477 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
17478 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
17479 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
17483 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
17485 @kindex dll-symbols
17487 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
17488 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
17490 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
17491 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
17492 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
17493 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
17494 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
17495 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
17496 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
17497 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
17498 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
17499 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
17500 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
17502 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
17503 @item show cygwin-exceptions
17504 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
17505 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
17507 @kindex set new-console
17508 @item set new-console @var{mode}
17509 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
17510 be started in a new console on next start.
17511 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
17512 be started in the same console as the debugger.
17514 @kindex show new-console
17515 @item show new-console
17516 Displays whether a new console is used
17517 when the debuggee is started.
17519 @kindex set new-group
17520 @item set new-group @var{mode}
17521 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
17522 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
17523 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
17526 @kindex show new-group
17527 @item show new-group
17528 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
17530 @kindex set debugevents
17531 @item set debugevents
17532 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
17533 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
17534 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
17535 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
17536 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
17538 @kindex set debugexec
17539 @item set debugexec
17540 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
17541 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
17543 @kindex set debugexceptions
17544 @item set debugexceptions
17545 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
17546 debuggee seen by the debugger.
17548 @kindex set debugmemory
17549 @item set debugmemory
17550 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
17551 and writes by the debugger.
17555 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
17556 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
17560 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
17565 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
17568 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
17569 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
17570 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
17571 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
17573 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
17574 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
17575 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
17576 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
17577 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
17578 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
17579 ``minimal symbols''.
17581 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
17582 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
17583 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
17584 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
17585 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
17586 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
17587 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
17588 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
17589 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
17590 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
17592 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
17594 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
17595 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
17596 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
17597 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
17598 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
17599 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
17600 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
17601 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
17602 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
17604 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
17605 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
17606 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
17607 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
17608 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
17609 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
17612 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
17613 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
17615 Non-debugging symbols:
17616 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
17617 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
17621 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
17622 All functions matching regular expression "!":
17624 Non-debugging symbols:
17625 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
17626 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
17627 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
17631 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
17633 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
17634 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
17635 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
17636 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
17637 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
17638 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
17639 a function within a DLL without a running program.
17641 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
17642 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
17643 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
17644 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
17648 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
17653 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
17654 0x10021610: "\230y\""
17657 And two possible solutions:
17660 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
17661 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17665 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
17666 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
17667 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
17668 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
17669 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
17670 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17673 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
17674 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
17675 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
17676 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
17677 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
17680 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
17681 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
17684 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
17685 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
17689 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
17690 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
17692 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
17693 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
17698 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
17699 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17700 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
17701 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
17702 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
17707 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
17708 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17709 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
17711 @item set signal-thread
17712 @itemx set sigthread
17713 @kindex set signal-thread
17714 @kindex set sigthread
17715 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
17716 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
17717 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
17720 @item show signal-thread
17721 @itemx show sigthread
17722 @kindex show signal-thread
17723 @kindex show sigthread
17724 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
17725 delivered a signal.
17728 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17729 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
17730 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
17731 continued by delivering a signal to it.
17734 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17735 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
17738 @item set exceptions
17739 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17740 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
17741 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
17742 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
17745 @item show exceptions
17746 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17747 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
17749 @item set task pause
17750 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
17751 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17752 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17753 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
17754 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
17755 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
17756 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
17757 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
17758 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
17760 @item show task pause
17761 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
17762 Show the current state of task suspension.
17764 @item set task detach-suspend-count
17765 @cindex task suspend count
17766 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17767 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
17768 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
17770 @item show task detach-suspend-count
17771 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
17773 @item set task exception-port
17774 @itemx set task excp
17775 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17776 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
17777 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
17778 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
17780 @item set noninvasive
17781 @cindex noninvasive task options
17782 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
17783 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
17784 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
17785 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
17787 @item info send-rights
17788 @itemx info receive-rights
17789 @itemx info port-rights
17790 @itemx info port-sets
17791 @itemx info dead-names
17794 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17795 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17796 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17797 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17798 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17799 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
17800 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
17801 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
17802 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
17804 @item set thread pause
17805 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
17806 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17807 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17808 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
17809 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
17810 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
17811 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
17812 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
17813 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
17814 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
17815 only the current thread.
17817 @item show thread pause
17818 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
17819 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
17821 @item set thread run
17822 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17824 @item show thread run
17825 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17827 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
17828 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17829 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17830 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
17831 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
17832 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
17833 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
17835 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
17836 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
17839 @item set thread exception-port
17840 @itemx set thread excp
17841 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
17842 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
17843 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
17845 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
17846 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
17847 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
17848 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
17850 @item set thread default
17851 @itemx show thread default
17852 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17853 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
17854 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
17855 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
17856 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
17857 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
17858 the non-default commands.
17863 @subsection QNX Neutrino
17864 @cindex QNX Neutrino
17866 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
17870 @item set debug nto-debug
17871 @kindex set debug nto-debug
17872 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
17875 @item show debug nto-debug
17876 @kindex show debug nto-debug
17877 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
17884 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
17887 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
17888 @kindex set debug darwin
17889 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
17890 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
17892 @item show debug darwin
17893 @kindex show debug darwin
17894 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
17896 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
17897 @kindex set debug mach-o
17898 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
17899 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
17900 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
17901 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
17902 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
17905 @item show debug mach-o
17906 @kindex show debug mach-o
17907 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
17909 @item set mach-exceptions on
17910 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
17911 @kindex set mach-exceptions
17912 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
17913 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
17914 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
17915 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
17917 @item show mach-exceptions
17918 @kindex show mach-exceptions
17919 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
17924 @section Embedded Operating Systems
17926 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
17927 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
17931 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17934 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
17935 various real-time operating systems.
17938 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17944 @kindex target vxworks
17945 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
17946 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
17947 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
17951 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
17952 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
17954 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
17955 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
17956 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
17957 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
17958 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
17959 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
17960 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
17963 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
17964 @kindex vxworks-timeout
17965 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
17966 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
17967 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
17968 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
17969 of a thin network line.
17972 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
17973 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
17976 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
17977 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
17978 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
17979 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
17980 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
17981 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
17982 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
17983 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
17985 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
17987 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
17988 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
17989 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
17990 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
17992 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
17999 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
18000 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
18001 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
18004 @node VxWorks Connection
18005 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
18007 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
18008 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
18011 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
18015 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
18018 Attaching remote machine across net...
18023 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
18024 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
18025 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
18026 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
18027 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
18030 prog.o: No such file or directory.
18033 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
18034 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
18037 @node VxWorks Download
18038 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
18040 @cindex download to VxWorks
18041 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
18042 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
18043 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
18044 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
18045 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
18046 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
18047 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
18048 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
18049 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
18050 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
18051 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
18052 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
18053 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
18054 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
18055 program, type this on VxWorks:
18058 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
18062 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18065 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
18066 (vxgdb) load prog.o
18069 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
18072 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
18075 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
18076 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
18077 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
18078 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
18079 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
18080 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
18083 @node VxWorks Attach
18084 @subsubsection Running Tasks
18086 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
18087 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
18091 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
18095 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
18096 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
18097 the time of attachment.
18099 @node Embedded Processors
18100 @section Embedded Processors
18102 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
18105 @cindex send command to simulator
18106 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
18107 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
18110 @item sim @var{command}
18111 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
18112 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
18113 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
18114 acceptable commands.
18120 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
18121 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
18122 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
18123 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
18124 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
18125 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
18126 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
18127 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
18128 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
18129 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
18132 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
18141 @item target rdi @var{dev}
18142 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
18143 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
18144 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
18147 @item target rdp @var{dev}
18152 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
18155 @item set arm disassembler
18157 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
18158 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
18160 @item show arm disassembler
18162 Show the current disassembly style.
18164 @item set arm apcs32
18165 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
18166 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
18168 @item show arm apcs32
18169 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
18171 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
18172 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
18173 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
18177 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
18179 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
18182 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
18184 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
18190 Show the current type of the FPU.
18193 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
18196 Show the currently used ABI.
18198 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18199 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
18200 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
18201 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
18202 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
18203 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
18206 @item show arm fallback-mode
18207 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
18209 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18210 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
18211 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
18212 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
18213 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
18215 @item show arm force-mode
18216 Show the current forced instruction mode.
18218 @item set debug arm
18219 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
18220 target support subsystem.
18222 @item show debug arm
18223 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
18226 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
18227 using the RDI interface:
18230 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18232 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
18233 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
18234 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
18235 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
18238 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
18239 @kindex rdilogenable
18240 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
18241 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
18242 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
18243 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
18244 are logged to a file.
18246 @item set rdiromatzero
18247 @kindex set rdiromatzero
18248 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
18249 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
18250 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
18251 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
18252 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
18254 @item show rdiromatzero
18255 @kindex show rdiromatzero
18256 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
18258 @item set rdiheartbeat
18259 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
18260 @cindex RDI heartbeat
18261 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
18262 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
18263 well as the Angel monitor.
18265 @item show rdiheartbeat
18266 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
18267 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
18271 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18272 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
18275 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
18276 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
18277 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
18278 The default value is @code{all}.
18291 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
18294 @kindex target m32r
18295 @item target m32r @var{dev}
18296 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
18298 @kindex target m32rsdi
18299 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
18300 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
18303 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
18306 @item set download-path @var{path}
18307 @kindex set download-path
18308 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
18309 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18311 @item show download-path
18312 @kindex show download-path
18313 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18315 @item set board-address @var{addr}
18316 @kindex set board-address
18317 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
18318 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
18320 @item show board-address
18321 @kindex show board-address
18322 Show the current IP address of the target board.
18324 @item set server-address @var{addr}
18325 @kindex set server-address
18326 @cindex download server address (M32R)
18327 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
18330 @item show server-address
18331 @kindex show server-address
18332 Display the IP address of the download server.
18334 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18335 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
18336 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
18337 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
18338 executable file is uploaded.
18340 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18341 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
18342 Test the @code{upload} command.
18345 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
18350 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
18351 This command resets the SDI connection.
18355 This command shows the SDI connection status.
18358 @kindex debug_chaos
18359 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
18360 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
18362 @item use_debug_dma
18363 @kindex use_debug_dma
18364 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
18367 @kindex use_mon_code
18368 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
18371 @kindex use_ib_break
18372 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
18374 @item use_dbt_break
18375 @kindex use_dbt_break
18376 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
18382 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
18383 target command for the following ROM monitor.
18387 @kindex target dbug
18388 @item target dbug @var{dev}
18389 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
18394 @subsection MicroBlaze
18395 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
18396 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
18398 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
18399 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
18400 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
18401 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
18402 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
18403 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
18404 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
18405 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
18406 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
18407 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
18408 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
18410 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
18413 @item target remote :1234
18414 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
18415 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
18417 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
18418 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
18419 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
18422 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
18424 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
18425 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
18427 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
18428 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
18431 @node MIPS Embedded
18432 @subsection MIPS Embedded
18434 @cindex MIPS boards
18435 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
18436 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
18437 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
18440 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
18443 @item target mips @var{port}
18444 @kindex target mips @var{port}
18445 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
18446 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
18447 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
18448 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
18449 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
18450 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
18452 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
18453 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
18457 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
18458 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
18459 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
18460 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
18464 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
18465 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
18466 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
18467 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
18468 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
18470 @item target pmon @var{port}
18471 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
18474 @item target ddb @var{port}
18475 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
18476 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
18478 @item target lsi @var{port}
18479 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
18480 LSI variant of PMON.
18482 @kindex target r3900
18483 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
18484 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
18486 @kindex target array
18487 @item target array @var{dev}
18488 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
18494 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
18497 @item set mipsfpu double
18498 @itemx set mipsfpu single
18499 @itemx set mipsfpu none
18500 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
18501 @itemx show mipsfpu
18502 @kindex set mipsfpu
18503 @kindex show mipsfpu
18504 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
18505 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
18506 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
18507 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
18508 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
18509 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
18510 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
18511 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
18512 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
18513 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
18514 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
18515 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
18516 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
18518 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
18519 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
18520 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
18522 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
18523 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
18525 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
18526 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
18527 @itemx show timeout
18528 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
18529 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
18530 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
18531 @kindex set timeout
18532 @kindex show timeout
18533 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
18534 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
18535 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
18536 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
18537 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
18538 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
18539 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
18540 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
18541 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
18542 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
18544 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
18545 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
18546 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
18547 to run before stopping.
18549 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
18550 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
18551 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
18552 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
18553 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
18554 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
18556 @item show syn-garbage-limit
18557 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
18558 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
18559 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
18561 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
18562 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
18563 @cindex remote monitor prompt
18564 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
18565 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
18575 @item show monitor-prompt
18576 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
18577 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
18580 @item set monitor-warnings
18581 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
18582 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
18583 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
18584 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
18585 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
18587 @item show monitor-warnings
18588 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
18589 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
18591 @item pmon @var{command}
18592 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
18593 @cindex send PMON command
18594 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
18595 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
18598 @node OpenRISC 1000
18599 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
18600 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
18602 @cindex or1k boards
18603 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
18604 about platform and commands.
18608 @kindex target jtag
18609 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
18611 Connects to remote JTAG server.
18612 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
18613 connected via parallel port to the board.
18615 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
18618 @item or1ksim @var{command}
18619 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
18620 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
18622 @kindex info or1k spr
18623 @item info or1k spr
18624 Displays spr groups.
18626 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
18627 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
18628 Displays register names in selected group.
18630 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
18631 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
18632 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
18633 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
18634 Shows information about specified spr register.
18637 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
18638 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
18639 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
18640 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
18641 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
18644 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
18645 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
18646 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
18647 triggers can be set using:
18650 Load effective address/data
18652 Store effective address/data
18654 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
18659 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
18660 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
18662 @code{htrace} commands:
18663 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
18666 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
18667 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
18668 or Data. For example:
18670 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18672 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18676 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
18678 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
18679 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
18681 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
18682 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
18684 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
18685 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
18687 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
18688 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
18691 @item htrace enable
18692 @itemx htrace disable
18693 Enables/disables the HW trace.
18695 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
18696 Clears currently recorded trace data.
18698 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
18699 will be written there.
18701 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
18702 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
18704 @item htrace mode continuous
18705 Set continuous trace mode.
18707 @item htrace mode suspend
18708 Set suspend trace mode.
18712 @node PowerPC Embedded
18713 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
18715 @cindex DVC register
18716 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
18717 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
18720 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
18721 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
18724 The DVC register will be automatically used whenever @value{GDBN} detects
18725 such pattern in a condition expression. This feature is available in native
18726 @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34 or newer.
18728 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
18731 @kindex set powerpc
18732 @item set powerpc soft-float
18733 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
18734 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
18735 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
18736 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18738 @item set powerpc vector-abi
18739 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
18740 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
18741 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
18742 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
18743 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
18744 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
18745 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18747 @kindex target dink32
18748 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
18749 DINK32 ROM monitor.
18751 @kindex target ppcbug
18752 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
18753 @kindex target ppcbug1
18754 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
18755 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
18758 @item target sds @var{dev}
18759 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
18762 @cindex SDS protocol
18763 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
18767 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
18768 @kindex set sdstimeout
18769 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
18770 default is 2 seconds.
18772 @item show sdstimeout
18773 @kindex show sdstimeout
18774 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
18776 @item sds @var{command}
18777 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
18778 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
18783 @subsection HP PA Embedded
18787 @kindex target op50n
18788 @item target op50n @var{dev}
18789 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
18791 @kindex target w89k
18792 @item target w89k @var{dev}
18793 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
18798 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
18802 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
18803 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
18804 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
18805 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
18806 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
18809 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
18810 @kindex remotetimeout
18811 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
18812 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
18813 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
18816 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
18817 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
18818 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
18819 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
18820 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
18823 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
18826 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
18829 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
18832 @cindex running, on Sparclet
18834 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
18835 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
18836 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
18838 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
18845 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
18846 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
18847 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
18848 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
18851 @node Sparclet File
18852 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
18854 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
18857 (gdbslet) file prog
18861 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
18862 @value{GDBN} locates
18863 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
18865 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
18866 files will be searched as well.
18867 @value{GDBN} locates
18868 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
18869 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
18871 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
18874 prog: No such file or directory.
18877 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
18878 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
18879 @code{target} command again.
18881 @node Sparclet Connection
18882 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
18884 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
18885 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
18888 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
18889 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
18890 main () at ../prog.c:3
18894 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
18900 @node Sparclet Download
18901 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
18903 @cindex download to Sparclet
18904 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
18905 you can use the @value{GDBN}
18906 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
18907 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
18909 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
18910 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
18911 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
18912 of each of the file's sections.
18913 For instance, if the program
18914 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
18915 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18918 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
18919 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
18922 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
18923 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
18924 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
18926 @node Sparclet Execution
18927 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
18929 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
18930 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
18931 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
18932 manual for the list of commands.
18936 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
18938 Starting program: prog
18939 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
18940 3 char *symarg = 0;
18942 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
18947 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
18951 @kindex target sparclite
18952 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
18953 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
18954 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
18955 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
18961 @subsection Zilog Z8000
18964 @cindex simulator, Z8000
18965 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
18967 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
18970 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
18971 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
18972 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
18973 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
18976 @item target sim @var{args}
18978 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
18979 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
18980 options, specify them via @var{args}.
18984 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
18985 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
18986 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
18987 to run your program, and so on.
18989 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
18990 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
18991 additional items of information as specially named registers:
18996 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
18999 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
19002 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
19006 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
19007 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
19008 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
19009 simulated clock ticks.
19012 @subsection Atmel AVR
19015 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
19016 following AVR-specific commands:
19019 @item info io_registers
19020 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
19021 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
19022 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
19023 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
19030 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
19031 following CRIS-specific commands:
19034 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
19035 @cindex CRIS version
19036 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
19037 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
19038 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
19040 @item show cris-version
19041 Show the current CRIS version.
19043 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
19044 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
19045 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
19046 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
19049 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
19050 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
19052 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
19054 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
19055 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
19056 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
19058 @item show cris-mode
19059 Show the current CRIS mode.
19063 @subsection Renesas Super-H
19066 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
19071 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
19072 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
19074 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
19075 @kindex set sh calling-convention
19076 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
19077 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
19078 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
19079 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
19080 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
19081 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
19082 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
19083 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
19084 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
19085 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
19087 @item show sh calling-convention
19088 @kindex show sh calling-convention
19089 Show the current calling convention setting.
19094 @node Architectures
19095 @section Architectures
19097 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
19098 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
19105 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
19106 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19111 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
19114 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
19115 @kindex set struct-convention
19116 @cindex struct return convention
19117 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
19118 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
19119 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
19120 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
19121 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
19122 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
19123 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
19124 be returned in a register.
19126 @item show struct-convention
19127 @kindex show struct-convention
19128 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
19137 @kindex set rstack_high_address
19138 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
19139 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
19140 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
19141 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
19142 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
19143 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
19144 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
19145 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
19146 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
19147 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
19148 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
19151 @kindex show rstack_high_address
19152 @item show rstack_high_address
19153 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
19161 See the following section.
19166 @cindex stack on Alpha
19167 @cindex stack on MIPS
19168 @cindex Alpha stack
19170 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
19171 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
19172 find the beginning of a function.
19174 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
19175 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
19176 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
19177 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
19181 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
19182 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
19183 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
19184 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
19185 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
19186 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
19187 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
19188 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
19190 @item show heuristic-fence-post
19191 Display the current limit.
19195 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
19196 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
19198 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
19202 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
19203 @kindex set mips abi
19204 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
19205 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
19206 values of @var{arg} are:
19210 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
19221 @item show mips abi
19222 @kindex show mips abi
19223 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
19226 @itemx show mipsfpu
19227 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
19229 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
19230 @kindex set mips mask-address
19231 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
19232 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
19233 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
19234 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
19235 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
19237 @item show mips mask-address
19238 @kindex show mips mask-address
19239 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
19242 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19243 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19244 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
19245 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
19246 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
19247 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
19249 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19250 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19251 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
19253 @item set debug mips
19254 @kindex set debug mips
19255 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
19256 target code in @value{GDBN}.
19258 @item show debug mips
19259 @kindex show debug mips
19260 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
19266 @cindex HPPA support
19268 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
19269 following special commands:
19272 @item set debug hppa
19273 @kindex set debug hppa
19274 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
19275 messages are to be displayed.
19277 @item show debug hppa
19278 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
19280 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
19281 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
19282 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
19283 given @var{address}.
19289 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19290 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
19293 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
19294 it provides the following special commands:
19297 @item info spu event
19299 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
19300 and pending event status.
19302 @item info spu signal
19303 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
19304 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
19305 notification channels.
19307 @item info spu mailbox
19308 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
19309 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
19310 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
19313 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19314 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19315 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19317 @item info spu proxydma
19318 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19319 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19320 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19324 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
19325 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
19329 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
19331 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
19332 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
19333 function. The default is @code{off}.
19335 @item show spu stop-on-load
19337 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
19339 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
19340 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
19341 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
19342 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
19343 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
19344 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
19346 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
19347 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
19352 @subsection PowerPC
19353 @cindex PowerPC architecture
19355 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
19356 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
19357 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
19358 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
19359 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
19361 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
19362 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
19363 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
19365 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
19366 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
19369 @node Controlling GDB
19370 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
19372 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
19373 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
19374 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
19379 * Editing:: Command editing
19380 * Command History:: Command history
19381 * Screen Size:: Screen size
19382 * Numbers:: Numbers
19383 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
19384 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
19385 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
19386 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
19394 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
19395 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
19396 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
19397 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
19398 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
19399 which one you are talking to.
19401 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
19402 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
19403 or a prompt that does not.
19407 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
19408 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
19410 @kindex show prompt
19412 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
19416 @section Command Editing
19418 @cindex command line editing
19420 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
19421 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
19422 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
19423 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
19424 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
19425 debugging sessions.
19427 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
19428 command @code{set}.
19431 @kindex set editing
19434 @itemx set editing on
19435 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
19437 @item set editing off
19438 Disable command line editing.
19440 @kindex show editing
19442 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
19445 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19446 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
19448 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19449 @xref{Command Line Editing},
19451 for more details about the Readline
19452 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
19453 encouraged to read that chapter.
19455 @node Command History
19456 @section Command History
19457 @cindex command history
19459 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
19460 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
19461 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
19464 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
19465 package, to provide the history facility.
19466 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19467 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
19469 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19470 @xref{Using History Interactively},
19472 for the detailed description of the History library.
19474 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
19475 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
19476 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
19477 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
19478 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
19479 pressed on a line by itself.
19481 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
19482 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
19483 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
19484 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
19486 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
19490 @cindex history substitution
19491 @cindex history file
19492 @kindex set history filename
19493 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
19494 @item set history filename @var{fname}
19495 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
19496 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
19497 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
19498 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
19499 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
19500 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
19501 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
19504 @cindex save command history
19505 @kindex set history save
19506 @item set history save
19507 @itemx set history save on
19508 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
19509 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
19511 @item set history save off
19512 Stop recording command history in a file.
19514 @cindex history size
19515 @kindex set history size
19516 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
19517 @item set history size @var{size}
19518 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
19519 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
19520 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
19523 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
19524 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
19525 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
19527 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
19528 @xref{Event Designators},
19532 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
19533 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
19534 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
19535 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
19536 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
19537 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
19538 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
19539 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
19541 The commands to control history expansion are:
19544 @item set history expansion on
19545 @itemx set history expansion
19546 @kindex set history expansion
19547 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
19549 @item set history expansion off
19550 Disable history expansion.
19553 @kindex show history
19555 @itemx show history filename
19556 @itemx show history save
19557 @itemx show history size
19558 @itemx show history expansion
19559 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
19560 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
19565 @kindex show commands
19566 @cindex show last commands
19567 @cindex display command history
19568 @item show commands
19569 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
19571 @item show commands @var{n}
19572 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
19574 @item show commands +
19575 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
19579 @section Screen Size
19580 @cindex size of screen
19581 @cindex pauses in output
19583 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
19584 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
19585 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
19586 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
19587 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
19588 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
19589 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
19590 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
19592 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
19593 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
19594 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
19595 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
19596 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
19603 @kindex show height
19604 @item set height @var{lpp}
19606 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
19608 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
19609 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
19610 commands display the current settings.
19612 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
19613 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
19614 file or to an editor buffer.
19616 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
19617 from wrapping its output.
19619 @item set pagination on
19620 @itemx set pagination off
19621 @kindex set pagination
19622 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
19623 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}. Note that
19624 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
19625 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
19627 @item show pagination
19628 @kindex show pagination
19629 Show the current pagination mode.
19634 @cindex number representation
19635 @cindex entering numbers
19637 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
19638 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
19639 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
19640 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
19641 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
19642 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
19643 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
19644 both input and output with the commands described below.
19647 @kindex set input-radix
19648 @item set input-radix @var{base}
19649 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
19650 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
19651 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
19655 set input-radix 012
19656 set input-radix 10.
19657 set input-radix 0xa
19661 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
19662 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
19663 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
19664 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
19665 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
19668 @kindex set output-radix
19669 @item set output-radix @var{base}
19670 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
19671 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
19672 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
19674 @kindex show input-radix
19675 @item show input-radix
19676 Display the current default base for numeric input.
19678 @kindex show output-radix
19679 @item show output-radix
19680 Display the current default base for numeric display.
19682 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
19686 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
19687 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
19688 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
19689 default value of 10.
19694 @section Configuring the Current ABI
19696 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
19697 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
19698 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
19705 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
19706 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
19707 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
19708 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
19709 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
19710 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
19711 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
19716 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
19719 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
19721 @item set osabi @var{abi}
19722 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
19725 @cindex float promotion
19727 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
19728 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
19729 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
19730 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
19731 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
19732 @code{double} and then passed.
19734 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
19735 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
19736 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
19739 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
19740 @item set coerce-float-to-double
19741 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
19742 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
19743 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
19745 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
19746 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
19749 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
19750 @item show coerce-float-to-double
19751 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
19755 @kindex show cp-abi
19756 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
19757 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
19758 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
19759 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
19760 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
19761 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
19762 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
19763 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
19764 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
19765 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
19770 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
19773 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
19775 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
19776 @itemx set cp-abi auto
19777 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
19780 @node Messages/Warnings
19781 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
19783 @cindex verbose operation
19784 @cindex optional warnings
19785 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
19786 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
19787 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
19788 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
19790 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
19791 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
19792 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
19795 @kindex set verbose
19796 @item set verbose on
19797 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19799 @item set verbose off
19800 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19802 @kindex show verbose
19804 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
19807 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
19808 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
19809 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
19814 @kindex set complaints
19815 @item set complaints @var{limit}
19816 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
19817 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
19818 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
19819 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
19821 @kindex show complaints
19822 @item show complaints
19823 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
19827 @anchor{confirmation requests}
19828 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
19829 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
19830 you try to run a program which is already running:
19834 The program being debugged has been started already.
19835 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
19838 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
19839 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
19843 @kindex set confirm
19845 @cindex confirmation
19846 @cindex stupid questions
19847 @item set confirm off
19848 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
19849 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
19850 automatically disables confirmation requests.
19852 @item set confirm on
19853 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
19855 @kindex show confirm
19857 Displays state of confirmation requests.
19861 @cindex command tracing
19862 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
19863 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
19864 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
19865 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
19868 @kindex set trace-commands
19869 @cindex command scripts, debugging
19870 @item set trace-commands on
19871 Enable command tracing.
19872 @item set trace-commands off
19873 Disable command tracing.
19874 @item show trace-commands
19875 Display the current state of command tracing.
19878 @node Debugging Output
19879 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
19880 @cindex optional debugging messages
19882 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
19883 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
19884 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
19885 section documents those commands.
19888 @kindex set exec-done-display
19889 @item set exec-done-display
19890 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
19891 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
19892 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
19893 @kindex show exec-done-display
19894 @item show exec-done-display
19895 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
19898 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
19899 @cindex architecture debugging info
19900 @item set debug arch
19901 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
19903 @item show debug arch
19904 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
19905 @item set debug aix-thread
19906 @cindex AIX threads
19907 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
19909 @item show debug aix-thread
19910 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
19911 @item set debug dwarf2-die
19912 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
19913 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
19914 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
19915 A value of zero turns off the display.
19916 @item show debug dwarf2-die
19917 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
19918 @item set debug displaced
19919 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
19920 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
19921 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
19922 @item show debug displaced
19923 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
19924 related to displaced stepping.
19925 @item set debug event
19926 @cindex event debugging info
19927 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
19929 @item show debug event
19930 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
19932 @item set debug expression
19933 @cindex expression debugging info
19934 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
19935 expression parsing. The default is off.
19936 @item show debug expression
19937 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
19938 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
19939 @item set debug frame
19940 @cindex frame debugging info
19941 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
19943 @item show debug frame
19944 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
19946 @item set debug gnu-nat
19947 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
19948 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
19949 @item show debug gnu-nat
19950 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
19951 @item set debug infrun
19952 @cindex inferior debugging info
19953 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
19954 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
19955 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
19956 @item show debug infrun
19957 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
19958 @item set debug lin-lwp
19959 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
19960 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
19961 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
19962 @item show debug lin-lwp
19963 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
19964 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
19965 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
19966 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
19967 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
19968 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
19969 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
19970 @item set debug observer
19971 @cindex observer debugging info
19972 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
19973 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
19974 @item show debug observer
19975 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
19976 @item set debug overload
19977 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
19978 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
19979 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
19981 @item show debug overload
19982 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
19984 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
19985 @cindex debug expression parser
19986 @item set debug parser
19987 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
19988 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
19989 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
19990 details. The default is off.
19991 @item show debug parser
19992 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
19993 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
19994 @cindex serial connections, debugging
19995 @cindex debug remote protocol
19996 @cindex remote protocol debugging
19997 @cindex display remote packets
19998 @item set debug remote
19999 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
20000 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
20001 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
20002 @item show debug remote
20003 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
20004 @item set debug serial
20005 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
20007 @item show debug serial
20008 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
20010 @item set debug solib-frv
20011 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
20012 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
20013 @item show debug solib-frv
20014 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
20016 @item set debug target
20017 @cindex target debugging info
20018 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
20019 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
20020 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
20021 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
20022 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
20023 @item show debug target
20024 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
20026 @item set debug timestamp
20027 @cindex timestampping debugging info
20028 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
20029 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
20031 @item show debug timestamp
20032 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
20034 @item set debugvarobj
20035 @cindex variable object debugging info
20036 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
20037 info. The default is off.
20038 @item show debugvarobj
20039 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
20041 @item set debug xml
20042 @cindex XML parser debugging
20043 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
20044 @item show debug xml
20045 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
20048 @node Other Misc Settings
20049 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
20050 @cindex miscellaneous settings
20053 @kindex set interactive-mode
20054 @item set interactive-mode
20055 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate interactively.
20056 If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate non-interactively,
20057 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} guesses which mode to use,
20058 based on whether the debugger was started in a terminal or not.
20060 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
20061 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
20062 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
20063 inside a cygwin window.
20065 @kindex show interactive-mode
20066 @item show interactive-mode
20067 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
20070 @node Extending GDB
20071 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
20072 @cindex extending GDB
20074 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
20075 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
20076 Python scripting language.
20078 To facilitate the use of these extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable
20079 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
20080 can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at
20081 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
20082 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20083 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
20085 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
20089 @kindex set script-extension
20090 @kindex show script-extension
20091 @item set script-extension off
20092 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20094 @item set script-extension soft
20095 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20096 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
20097 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
20098 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
20100 @item set script-extension strict
20101 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20102 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
20103 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
20105 @item show script-extension
20106 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
20111 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
20112 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20116 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
20118 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
20119 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
20120 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
20124 * Define:: How to define your own commands
20125 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
20126 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
20127 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
20131 @subsection User-defined Commands
20133 @cindex user-defined command
20134 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
20135 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
20136 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
20137 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
20138 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
20139 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
20143 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20148 To execute the command use:
20155 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
20156 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
20157 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
20160 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
20161 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
20162 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
20163 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
20168 print $arg0 + $arg1
20171 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20179 @item define @var{commandname}
20180 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
20181 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
20182 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
20183 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
20184 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
20185 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
20187 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
20188 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
20189 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20192 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
20193 @item document @var{commandname}
20194 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
20195 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
20196 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
20197 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
20198 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
20199 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
20201 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
20202 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
20203 does not change the documentation.
20205 @kindex dont-repeat
20206 @cindex don't repeat command
20208 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
20209 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
20210 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
20212 @kindex help user-defined
20213 @item help user-defined
20214 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
20219 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
20220 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
20221 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
20222 definitions for all user-defined commands.
20224 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
20225 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
20226 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
20227 @item show max-user-call-depth
20228 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
20229 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
20230 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
20231 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20234 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
20235 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
20237 When user-defined commands are executed, the
20238 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
20239 stops execution of the user-defined command.
20241 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
20242 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
20243 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
20244 messages when used in a user-defined command.
20247 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
20248 @cindex command hooks
20249 @cindex hooks, for commands
20250 @cindex hooks, pre-command
20253 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
20254 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
20255 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
20256 before that command.
20258 @cindex hooks, post-command
20260 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
20261 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
20262 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
20263 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
20264 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
20266 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
20267 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
20269 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
20270 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
20272 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
20273 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
20274 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
20275 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
20276 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
20278 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
20279 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
20284 handle SIGALRM nopass
20288 handle SIGALRM pass
20291 define hook-continue
20292 handle SIGALRM pass
20296 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
20297 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
20305 define hookpost-echo
20309 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
20310 <<<---Hello World--->>>
20315 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
20316 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
20317 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
20318 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
20320 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
20321 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
20322 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
20324 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
20325 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
20326 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
20328 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
20329 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
20331 @node Command Files
20332 @subsection Command Files
20334 @cindex command files
20335 @cindex scripting commands
20336 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
20337 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
20338 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
20339 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
20342 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
20343 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
20344 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
20345 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
20346 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
20350 @cindex execute commands from a file
20351 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
20352 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
20355 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
20356 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
20357 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
20358 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
20359 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
20361 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
20362 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
20363 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
20364 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
20365 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
20366 is not relevant to scripts.
20368 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
20369 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
20370 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
20371 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
20372 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
20373 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
20374 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
20375 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
20376 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
20377 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
20378 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
20379 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
20380 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
20381 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
20383 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
20384 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
20385 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
20387 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
20388 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
20389 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
20390 when called from command files.
20392 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
20393 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
20394 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
20395 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
20399 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
20402 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
20403 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
20404 would be directed to @file{log}.
20406 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
20407 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
20408 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
20409 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
20410 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
20411 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
20412 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
20413 conditionally, etc.
20420 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
20421 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
20422 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
20423 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
20424 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
20425 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
20426 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20430 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
20431 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
20432 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
20433 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
20434 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
20435 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
20439 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
20440 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
20443 @kindex loop_continue
20444 @item loop_continue
20445 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
20446 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
20447 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
20448 the controlling expression.
20450 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
20452 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
20453 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
20458 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
20460 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
20461 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
20462 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
20463 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
20468 @item echo @var{text}
20469 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
20470 @c because it is not in ANSI.
20471 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
20472 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
20473 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
20474 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
20475 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
20476 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
20477 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
20478 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
20479 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
20481 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
20482 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
20485 echo This is some text\n\
20486 which is continued\n\
20487 onto several lines.\n
20490 produces the same output as
20493 echo This is some text\n
20494 echo which is continued\n
20495 echo onto several lines.\n
20499 @item output @var{expression}
20500 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
20501 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
20502 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
20505 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
20506 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
20507 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
20508 Formats}, for more information.
20511 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
20512 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
20513 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
20514 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
20515 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
20516 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
20517 executing the code below:
20520 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
20523 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
20524 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
20525 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
20526 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
20527 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
20530 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
20533 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
20536 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
20537 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
20538 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
20542 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
20545 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
20549 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
20550 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
20553 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
20557 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
20560 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
20564 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
20565 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
20566 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
20567 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
20569 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
20570 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
20571 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
20572 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
20575 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
20576 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
20577 together with a floating point specifier.
20582 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
20585 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
20588 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
20591 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
20592 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
20593 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
20595 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
20596 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
20598 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
20600 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
20604 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
20605 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
20606 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
20611 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20612 @cindex python scripting
20613 @cindex scripting with python
20615 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
20616 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
20617 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
20619 @cindex python directory
20620 Python scripts used by @value{GDBN} should be installed in
20621 @file{@var{data-directory}/python}, where @var{data-directory} is
20622 the data directory as determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).
20623 This directory, known as the @dfn{python directory},
20624 is automatically added to the Python Search Path in order to allow
20625 the Python interpreter to locate all scripts installed at this location.
20628 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
20629 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
20630 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
20631 * Python modules:: Python modules provided by @value{GDBN}.
20634 @node Python Commands
20635 @subsection Python Commands
20636 @cindex python commands
20637 @cindex commands to access python
20639 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
20640 and one related setting:
20644 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
20645 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
20647 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
20648 argument as a Python command. For example:
20651 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
20655 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
20656 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
20657 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
20658 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
20659 containing @code{end}. For example:
20662 (@value{GDBP}) python
20664 End with a line saying just "end".
20670 @kindex maint set python print-stack
20671 @item maint set python print-stack
20672 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
20673 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
20674 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
20675 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
20679 It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
20683 @item source @file{script-name}
20684 The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
20685 to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
20686 the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
20688 @item python execfile ("script-name")
20689 This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
20690 and thus is always available.
20694 @subsection Python API
20696 @cindex programming in python
20698 @cindex python stdout
20699 @cindex python pagination
20700 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
20701 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
20702 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
20703 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
20704 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
20707 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
20708 * Exception Handling::
20709 * Values From Inferior::
20710 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
20711 * Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
20712 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
20713 * Writing a Pretty-Printer:: Writing a Pretty-Printer.
20714 * Inferiors In Python:: Python representation of inferiors (processes)
20715 * Threads In Python:: Accessing inferior threads from Python.
20716 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
20717 * Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
20718 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
20719 * Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
20720 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
20721 * Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
20722 * Blocks In Python:: Accessing frame blocks from Python.
20723 * Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
20724 * Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
20725 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
20726 * Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
20730 @subsubsection Basic Python
20732 @cindex python functions
20733 @cindex python module
20735 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
20736 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
20737 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
20738 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
20740 @findex gdb.PYTHONDIR
20742 A string containing the python directory (@pxref{Python}).
20745 @findex gdb.execute
20746 @defun execute command [from_tty] [to_string]
20747 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
20748 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
20749 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
20751 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
20752 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
20753 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
20755 By default, any output produced by @var{command} is sent to
20756 @value{GDBN}'s standard output. If the @var{to_string} parameter is
20757 @code{True}, then output will be collected by @code{gdb.execute} and
20758 returned as a string. The default is @code{False}, in which case the
20759 return value is @code{None}. If @var{to_string} is @code{True}, the
20760 @value{GDBN} virtual terminal will be temporarily set to unlimited width
20761 and height, and its pagination will be disabled; @pxref{Screen Size}.
20764 @findex gdb.breakpoints
20766 Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
20767 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
20770 @findex gdb.parameter
20771 @defun parameter parameter
20772 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
20773 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
20774 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
20775 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
20777 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
20778 @code{gdb.error} (@pxref{Exception Handling}). Otherwise, the
20779 parameter's value is converted to a Python value of the appropriate
20780 type, and returned.
20783 @findex gdb.history
20784 @defun history number
20785 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
20786 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
20787 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
20788 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
20789 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
20790 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
20791 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{gdb.error} exception will be
20794 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
20795 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
20798 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
20799 @defun parse_and_eval expression
20800 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
20801 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20802 @var{expression} must be a string.
20804 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
20805 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
20806 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
20807 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
20808 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20811 @findex gdb.post_event
20812 @defun post_event event
20813 Put @var{event}, a callable object taking no arguments, into
20814 @value{GDBN}'s internal event queue. This callable will be invoked at
20815 some later point, during @value{GDBN}'s event processing. Events
20816 posted using @code{post_event} will be run in the order in which they
20817 were posted; however, there is no way to know when they will be
20818 processed relative to other events inside @value{GDBN}.
20820 @value{GDBN} is not thread-safe. If your Python program uses multiple
20821 threads, you must be careful to only call @value{GDBN}-specific
20822 functions in the main @value{GDBN} thread. @code{post_event} ensures
20826 (@value{GDBP}) python
20830 > def __init__(self, message):
20831 > self.message = message;
20832 > def __call__(self):
20833 > gdb.write(self.message)
20835 >class MyThread1 (threading.Thread):
20837 > gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello "))
20839 >class MyThread2 (threading.Thread):
20841 > gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n"))
20843 >MyThread1().start()
20844 >MyThread2().start()
20846 (@value{GDBP}) Hello World
20851 @defun write string
20852 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
20853 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
20854 call this function.
20859 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
20860 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
20864 @findex gdb.target_charset
20865 @defun target_charset
20866 Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
20867 Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
20868 that @samp{auto} is never returned.
20871 @findex gdb.target_wide_charset
20872 @defun target_wide_charset
20873 Return the name of the current target wide character set
20874 (@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
20875 @code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
20879 @findex gdb.solib_name
20880 @defun solib_name address
20881 Return the name of the shared library holding the given @var{address}
20882 as a string, or @code{None}.
20885 @findex gdb.decode_line
20886 @defun decode_line @r{[}expression@r{]}
20887 Return locations of the line specified by @var{expression}, or of the
20888 current line if no argument was given. This function returns a Python
20889 tuple containing two elements. The first element contains a string
20890 holding any unparsed section of @var{expression} (or @code{None} if
20891 the expression has been fully parsed). The second element contains
20892 either @code{None} or another tuple that contains all the locations
20893 that match the expression represented as @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line}
20894 objects (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}). If @var{expression} is
20895 provided, it is decoded the way that @value{GDBN}'s inbuilt
20896 @code{break} or @code{edit} commands do (@pxref{Specify Location}).
20899 @node Exception Handling
20900 @subsubsection Exception Handling
20901 @cindex python exceptions
20902 @cindex exceptions, python
20904 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
20905 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
20906 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
20907 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
20908 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
20909 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
20910 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
20913 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
20914 Traceback (most recent call last):
20915 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
20916 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
20919 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by
20920 Python code are converted to Python exceptions. The type of the
20921 Python exception depends on the error.
20925 This is the base class for most exceptions generated by @value{GDBN}.
20926 It is derived from @code{RuntimeError}, for compatibility with earlier
20927 versions of @value{GDBN}.
20929 If an error occurring in @value{GDBN} does not fit into some more
20930 specific category, then the generated exception will have this type.
20932 @item gdb.MemoryError
20933 This is a subclass of @code{gdb.error} which is thrown when an
20934 operation tried to access invalid memory in the inferior.
20936 @item KeyboardInterrupt
20937 User interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
20938 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception.
20941 In all cases, your exception handler will see the @value{GDBN} error
20942 message as its value and the Python call stack backtrace at the Python
20943 statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
20946 @findex gdb.GdbError
20947 When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
20948 it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
20949 traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
20950 command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
20951 to handle this case. Example:
20955 >class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
20956 > """Greet the whole world."""
20957 > def __init__ (self):
20958 > super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
20959 > def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
20960 > argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
20961 > if len (argv) != 0:
20962 > raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
20963 > print "Hello, World!"
20966 (gdb) hello-world 42
20967 hello-world takes no arguments
20970 @node Values From Inferior
20971 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
20972 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
20973 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
20975 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
20976 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
20977 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
20978 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
20979 fetching values when necessary.
20981 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
20982 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
20983 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
20990 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
20991 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
20993 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
20994 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
20995 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
20996 can access its @code{foo} element with:
20999 bar = some_val['foo']
21002 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
21004 A @code{gdb.Value} that represents a function can be executed via
21005 inferior function call. Any arguments provided to the call must match
21006 the function's prototype, and must be provided in the order specified
21009 For example, @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance
21010 representing a function that takes two integers as arguments. To
21011 execute this function, call it like so:
21014 result = some_val (10,20)
21017 Any values returned from a function call will be stored as a
21020 The following attributes are provided:
21023 @defivar Value address
21024 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
21025 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
21026 this attribute holds @code{None}.
21029 @cindex optimized out value in Python
21030 @defivar Value is_optimized_out
21031 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
21032 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
21035 @defivar Value type
21036 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
21037 @code{gdb.Type} object (@pxref{Types In Python}).
21040 @defivar Value dynamic_type
21041 The dynamic type of this @code{gdb.Value}. This uses C@t{++} run-time
21042 type information (@acronym{RTTI}) to determine the dynamic type of the
21043 value. If this value is of class type, it will return the class in
21044 which the value is embedded, if any. If this value is of pointer or
21045 reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type of the
21046 referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type,
21047 respectively. In all other cases, it will return the value's static
21050 Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C@t{++} program
21051 that includes @acronym{RTTI} for the object in question. Otherwise,
21052 it will just return the static type of the value as in @kbd{ptype foo}
21053 (@pxref{Symbols, ptype}).
21057 The following methods are provided:
21060 @defmethod Value __init__ @var{val}
21061 Many Python values can be converted directly to a @code{gdb.Value} via
21062 this object initializer. Specifically:
21065 @item Python boolean
21066 A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current
21069 @item Python integer
21070 A Python integer is converted to the C @code{long} type for the
21071 current architecture.
21074 A Python long is converted to the C @code{long long} type for the
21075 current architecture.
21078 A Python float is converted to the C @code{double} type for the
21079 current architecture.
21081 @item Python string
21082 A Python string is converted to a target string, using the current
21085 @item @code{gdb.Value}
21086 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.Value}, then a copy of the value is made.
21088 @item @code{gdb.LazyString}
21089 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings In
21090 Python}), then the lazy string's @code{value} method is called, and
21091 its result is used.
21095 @defmethod Value cast type
21096 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
21097 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
21098 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
21099 reason, this method throws an exception.
21102 @defmethod Value dereference
21103 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
21104 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
21105 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
21112 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
21113 @code{foo} points to like this:
21116 bar = foo.dereference ()
21119 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
21120 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
21123 @defmethod Value dynamic_cast type
21124 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{dynamic_cast}
21125 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21128 @defmethod Value reinterpret_cast type
21129 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{reinterpret_cast}
21130 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21133 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
21134 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21135 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
21136 throw an exception.
21138 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
21139 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
21142 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
21143 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
21144 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
21145 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
21146 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
21148 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21149 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
21150 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
21151 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
21152 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
21153 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
21154 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
21155 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
21156 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
21158 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
21159 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
21161 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21162 fetched and converted to the given length.
21165 @defmethod Value lazy_string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
21166 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21167 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
21168 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
21170 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21171 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
21172 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
21173 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
21174 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
21176 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
21177 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
21178 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
21179 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
21180 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
21181 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
21183 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21184 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
21185 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
21186 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
21190 @node Types In Python
21191 @subsubsection Types In Python
21192 @cindex types in Python
21193 @cindex Python, working with types
21196 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
21199 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21202 @findex gdb.lookup_type
21203 @defun lookup_type name [block]
21204 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
21205 type to look up. It must be a string.
21207 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
21208 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
21210 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
21211 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
21214 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
21218 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
21219 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
21222 @defivar Type sizeof
21223 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
21224 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
21225 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
21229 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
21230 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
21231 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
21232 @code{None} is returned.
21236 The following methods are provided:
21239 @defmethod Type fields
21240 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
21241 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
21242 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
21243 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
21244 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
21245 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
21247 Each field is an object, with some pre-defined attributes:
21250 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
21251 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
21252 position of the field.
21255 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
21258 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
21259 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
21260 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
21262 @item is_base_class
21263 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
21264 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
21265 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
21266 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
21269 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
21270 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
21271 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
21274 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
21275 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
21279 @defmethod Type array @var{n1} @r{[}@var{n2}@r{]}
21280 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an array of this
21281 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
21282 the array; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
21283 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the array, and the
21284 second argument is the upper bound of the array. An array's length
21285 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
21288 @defmethod Type const
21289 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
21290 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
21293 @defmethod Type volatile
21294 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
21295 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
21298 @defmethod Type unqualified
21299 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
21300 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
21304 @defmethod Type range
21305 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
21306 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
21307 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
21308 @code{gdb.error} exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
21311 @defmethod Type reference
21312 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
21316 @defmethod Type pointer
21317 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
21321 @defmethod Type strip_typedefs
21322 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
21323 after removing all layers of typedefs.
21326 @defmethod Type target
21327 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
21330 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
21331 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
21332 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
21333 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
21334 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
21335 target type is the aliased type.
21337 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
21341 @defmethod Type template_argument n [block]
21342 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
21343 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
21344 @var{n}th template argument.
21346 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
21347 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
21349 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
21350 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
21355 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
21356 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
21357 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
21360 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
21361 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
21362 @item TYPE_CODE_PTR
21363 The type is a pointer.
21365 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21366 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21367 @item TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21368 The type is an array.
21370 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21371 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21372 @item TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21373 The type is a structure.
21375 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
21376 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
21377 @item TYPE_CODE_UNION
21378 The type is a union.
21380 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21381 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21382 @item TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21383 The type is an enum.
21385 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21386 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21387 @item TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21388 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
21390 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21391 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21392 @item TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21393 The type is a function.
21395 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
21396 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
21397 @item TYPE_CODE_INT
21398 The type is an integer type.
21400 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
21401 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
21402 @item TYPE_CODE_FLT
21403 A floating point type.
21405 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
21406 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
21407 @item TYPE_CODE_VOID
21408 The special type @code{void}.
21410 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
21411 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
21412 @item TYPE_CODE_SET
21415 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21416 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21417 @item TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21418 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
21420 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
21421 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
21422 @item TYPE_CODE_STRING
21423 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
21424 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
21426 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21427 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21428 @item TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21431 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21432 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21433 @item TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21434 An unknown or erroneous type.
21436 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21437 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21438 @item TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21439 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
21441 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21442 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21443 @item TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21444 A pointer-to-member-function.
21446 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21447 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21448 @item TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21449 A pointer-to-member.
21451 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
21452 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
21453 @item TYPE_CODE_REF
21456 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21457 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21458 @item TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21461 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21462 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21463 @item TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21466 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21467 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21468 @item TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21469 A complex float type.
21471 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21472 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21473 @item TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21474 A typedef to some other type.
21476 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21477 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21478 @item TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21479 A C@t{++} namespace.
21481 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21482 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21483 @item TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21484 A decimal floating point type.
21486 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21487 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21488 @item TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21489 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
21490 convenience functions.
21493 Further support for types is provided in the @code{gdb.types}
21494 Python module (@pxref{gdb.types}).
21496 @node Pretty Printing API
21497 @subsubsection Pretty Printing API
21499 An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
21501 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
21502 specific interface, defined here.
21504 @defop Operation {pretty printer} children (self)
21505 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
21506 children of the pretty-printer's value.
21508 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
21509 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
21510 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
21511 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
21512 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
21514 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
21515 as though the value has no children.
21518 @defop Operation {pretty printer} display_hint (self)
21519 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
21520 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
21521 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
21524 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
21527 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
21531 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
21532 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
21533 @code{set print array}.
21536 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
21537 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
21541 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
21542 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
21543 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
21544 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
21545 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
21546 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
21550 @defop Operation {pretty printer} to_string (self)
21551 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
21552 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
21554 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
21555 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
21556 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
21557 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
21558 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
21559 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
21560 the result of @code{children}.
21562 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
21564 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
21565 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
21566 another pretty-printer.
21568 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
21569 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
21570 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
21571 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
21572 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
21574 Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
21575 are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
21577 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
21580 @value{GDBN} provides a function which can be used to look up the
21581 default pretty-printer for a @code{gdb.Value}:
21583 @findex gdb.default_visualizer
21584 @defun default_visualizer value
21585 This function takes a @code{gdb.Value} object as an argument. If a
21586 pretty-printer for this value exists, then it is returned. If no such
21587 printer exists, then this returns @code{None}.
21590 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
21591 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
21593 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
21594 functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition
21595 as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list are called @code{global}
21596 printers, they're available when debugging all inferiors.
21597 Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
21598 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
21601 Each function on these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
21602 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
21603 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
21604 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
21607 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
21608 @code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
21609 each enabled lookup routine in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile}
21610 until it receives a pretty-printer object.
21611 If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
21612 searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
21613 calling each enabled function until an object is returned.
21614 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
21615 @code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an
21616 object is returned.
21618 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
21619 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
21620 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
21621 object is returned.
21623 For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work.
21624 For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and
21625 the pretty-printer is out of date.
21627 The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that
21628 @value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual
21629 printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on,
21630 a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed
21631 with a broken printer.
21633 Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled}
21634 attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute
21635 is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise
21636 the printer is enabled.
21638 @node Writing a Pretty-Printer
21639 @subsubsection Writing a Pretty-Printer
21640 @cindex writing a pretty-printer
21642 A pretty-printer consists of two parts: a lookup function to detect
21643 if the type is supported, and the printer itself.
21645 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
21646 written. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for details on the API this class
21650 class StdStringPrinter(object):
21651 "Print a std::string"
21653 def __init__(self, val):
21656 def to_string(self):
21657 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
21659 def display_hint(self):
21663 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
21664 example above might be written.
21667 def str_lookup_function(val):
21668 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
21669 if lookup_tag == None:
21671 regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
21672 if regex.match(lookup_tag):
21673 return StdStringPrinter(val)
21677 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
21678 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
21679 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
21680 returns @code{None}.
21682 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
21683 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
21684 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
21685 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
21686 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
21689 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
21690 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
21691 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
21692 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
21693 the current objfile.
21695 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
21696 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
21697 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
21698 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
21699 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
21700 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
21701 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
21702 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
21705 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
21706 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
21709 def register_printers(objfile):
21710 objfile.pretty_printers.add(str_lookup_function)
21714 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
21717 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
21718 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile())
21721 The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer.
21722 There are a few things that can be improved on.
21723 The printer doesn't have a name, making it hard to identify in a
21724 list of installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but
21725 lookup functions can have arbitrary, even identical, names.
21727 Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has
21728 several types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type
21729 in the library, but one could also have a single lookup function recognize
21730 several types. The latter is the conventional way this is handled.
21731 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
21732 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
21734 The @code{gdb.printing} module provides a formal way of solving these
21735 problems (@pxref{gdb.printing}).
21736 Here is another example that handles multiple types.
21738 These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
21741 struct foo @{ int a, b; @};
21742 struct bar @{ struct foo x, y; @};
21745 Here are the printers:
21749 """Print a foo object."""
21751 def __init__(self, val):
21754 def to_string(self):
21755 return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) +
21756 "> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">")
21759 """Print a bar object."""
21761 def __init__(self, val):
21764 def to_string(self):
21765 return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) +
21766 "> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">")
21769 This example doesn't need a lookup function, that is handled by the
21770 @code{gdb.printing} module. Instead a function is provided to build up
21771 the object that handles the lookup.
21774 import gdb.printing
21776 def build_pretty_printer():
21777 pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter(
21779 pp.add_printer('foo', '^foo$', fooPrinter)
21780 pp.add_printer('bar', '^bar$', barPrinter)
21784 And here is the autoload support:
21787 import gdb.printing
21789 gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer(
21790 gdb.current_objfile(),
21791 my_library.build_pretty_printer())
21794 Finally, when this printer is loaded into @value{GDBN}, here is the
21795 corresponding output of @samp{info pretty-printer}:
21798 (gdb) info pretty-printer
21805 @node Inferiors In Python
21806 @subsubsection Inferiors In Python
21807 @cindex inferiors in python
21809 @findex gdb.Inferior
21810 Programs which are being run under @value{GDBN} are called inferiors
21811 (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). Python scripts can access
21812 information about and manipulate inferiors controlled by @value{GDBN}
21813 via objects of the @code{gdb.Inferior} class.
21815 The following inferior-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21819 Return a tuple containing all inferior objects.
21822 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following attributes:
21825 @defivar Inferior num
21826 ID of inferior, as assigned by GDB.
21829 @defivar Inferior pid
21830 Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating
21834 @defivar Inferior was_attached
21835 Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using `attach', or
21836 started by @value{GDBN} itself.
21840 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following methods:
21843 @defmethod Inferior threads
21844 This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid
21845 when it is called. If there are no valid threads, the method will
21846 return an empty tuple.
21849 @findex gdb.read_memory
21850 @defmethod Inferior read_memory address length
21851 Read @var{length} bytes of memory from the inferior, starting at
21852 @var{address}. Returns a buffer object, which behaves much like an array
21853 or a string. It can be modified and given to the @code{gdb.write_memory}
21857 @findex gdb.write_memory
21858 @defmethod Inferior write_memory address buffer @r{[}length@r{]}
21859 Write the contents of @var{buffer} to the inferior, starting at
21860 @var{address}. The @var{buffer} parameter must be a Python object
21861 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
21862 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. If given, @var{length}
21863 determines the number of bytes from @var{buffer} to be written.
21866 @findex gdb.search_memory
21867 @defmethod Inferior search_memory address length pattern
21868 Search a region of the inferior memory starting at @var{address} with
21869 the given @var{length} using the search pattern supplied in
21870 @var{pattern}. The @var{pattern} parameter must be a Python object
21871 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
21872 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. Returns a Python @code{Long}
21873 containing the address where the pattern was found, or @code{None} if
21874 the pattern could not be found.
21878 @node Threads In Python
21879 @subsubsection Threads In Python
21880 @cindex threads in python
21882 @findex gdb.InferiorThread
21883 Python scripts can access information about, and manipulate inferior threads
21884 controlled by @value{GDBN}, via objects of the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} class.
21886 The following thread-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21889 @findex gdb.selected_thread
21890 @defun selected_thread
21891 This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there
21892 is no selected thread, this will return @code{None}.
21895 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following attributes:
21898 @defivar InferiorThread num
21899 ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB.
21902 @defivar InferiorThread ptid
21903 ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a
21904 tuple containing three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second
21905 is the Lightweight Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID).
21906 Either the LWPID or TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system
21907 does not use that identifier.
21911 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following methods:
21914 @defmethod InferiorThread switch
21915 This changes @value{GDBN}'s currently selected thread to the one represented
21919 @defmethod InferiorThread is_stopped
21920 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped.
21923 @defmethod InferiorThread is_running
21924 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running.
21927 @defmethod InferiorThread is_exited
21928 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited.
21932 @node Commands In Python
21933 @subsubsection Commands In Python
21935 @cindex commands in python
21936 @cindex python commands
21937 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
21938 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
21939 class, most commonly using a subclass.
21941 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
21942 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
21943 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
21944 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
21946 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
21947 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
21948 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
21949 an exception is raised.
21951 There is no support for multi-line commands.
21953 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
21954 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
21955 new command in the help system.
21957 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
21958 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
21959 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
21960 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
21961 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
21962 error will occur when completion is attempted.
21964 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
21965 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
21968 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
21969 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
21970 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
21971 not documented.'' is used.
21974 @cindex don't repeat Python command
21975 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
21976 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
21977 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
21978 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
21979 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
21982 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
21983 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
21985 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
21986 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
21988 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
21989 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
21990 that the command came from elsewhere.
21992 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
21993 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
21995 @findex gdb.string_to_argv
21996 To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
21997 @code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
21998 @value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
21999 It is recommended to use this for consistency.
22000 Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
22004 print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
22005 ['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
22010 @cindex completion of Python commands
22011 @defmethod Command complete text word
22012 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
22013 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
22014 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
22015 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
22018 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
22019 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
22020 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
22021 using a word-breaking heuristic.
22023 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
22026 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
22027 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
22028 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
22029 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
22030 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
22031 sequence are ignored.
22034 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
22035 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
22036 function is invoked, and its result is used.
22039 All other results are treated as though there were no available
22044 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
22045 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
22046 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
22047 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
22048 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
22049 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22052 @findex COMMAND_NONE
22053 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
22055 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
22056 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
22058 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
22059 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
22060 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
22061 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
22062 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
22063 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22064 commands in this category.
22066 @findex COMMAND_DATA
22067 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
22069 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
22070 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
22071 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
22074 @findex COMMAND_STACK
22075 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
22076 @item COMMAND_STACK
22077 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
22078 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
22079 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
22080 list of commands in this category.
22082 @findex COMMAND_FILES
22083 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
22084 @item COMMAND_FILES
22085 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
22086 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
22087 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22088 commands in this category.
22090 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
22091 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
22092 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
22093 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
22094 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
22095 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
22096 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
22097 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22098 commands in this category.
22100 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
22101 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
22102 @item COMMAND_STATUS
22103 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
22104 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
22105 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
22106 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
22108 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22109 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22110 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22111 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
22112 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
22113 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
22116 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22117 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22118 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22119 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
22120 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
22121 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22122 commands in this category.
22124 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
22125 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
22126 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
22127 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
22128 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
22129 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
22130 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
22133 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22134 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22135 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22136 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
22137 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
22138 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22139 commands in this category.
22142 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
22143 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
22144 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
22145 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22148 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
22149 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
22150 @item COMPLETE_NONE
22151 This constant means that no completion should be done.
22153 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
22154 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
22155 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
22156 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
22158 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
22159 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
22160 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
22161 This constant means that location completion should be done.
22162 @xref{Specify Location}.
22164 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
22165 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
22166 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
22167 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
22170 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22171 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22172 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22173 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
22177 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
22178 implemented in Python:
22181 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
22182 """Greet the whole world."""
22184 def __init__ (self):
22185 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
22187 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
22188 print "Hello, World!"
22193 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
22194 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
22195 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
22196 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
22198 @node Parameters In Python
22199 @subsubsection Parameters In Python
22201 @cindex parameters in python
22202 @cindex python parameters
22203 @tindex gdb.Parameter
22205 You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
22206 parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
22209 Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
22210 @code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
22212 There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
22213 @value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
22214 @code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
22215 behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
22216 can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
22218 @defmethod Parameter __init__ name @var{command-class} @var{parameter-class} @r{[}@var{enum-sequence}@r{]}
22219 The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
22220 parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
22221 from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
22223 @var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
22224 of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
22225 parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
22226 @code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
22227 @code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
22228 parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
22229 @value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
22231 If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
22232 can be found, an exception is raised.
22234 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
22235 (@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
22236 categorize the new parameter in the help system.
22238 @var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
22239 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
22240 parameter; this information is used for input validation and
22243 If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
22244 @var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
22245 represent the possible values for the parameter.
22247 If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
22248 of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
22250 The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
22251 documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
22252 there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
22255 @defivar Parameter set_doc
22256 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
22257 the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
22258 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
22262 @defivar Parameter show_doc
22263 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
22264 the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
22265 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
22269 @defivar Parameter value
22270 The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
22271 parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
22272 attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
22276 When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
22277 available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
22281 @findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
22282 @findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
22283 @item PARAM_BOOLEAN
22284 The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
22285 and @code{False} are the only valid values.
22287 @findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22288 @findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22289 @item PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22290 The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
22291 Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
22292 @samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
22294 @findex PARAM_UINTEGER
22295 @findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
22296 @item PARAM_UINTEGER
22297 The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
22298 interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
22300 @findex PARAM_INTEGER
22301 @findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
22302 @item PARAM_INTEGER
22303 The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
22304 to mean ``unlimited''.
22306 @findex PARAM_STRING
22307 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
22309 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
22310 sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
22311 translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
22314 @findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22315 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22316 @item PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22317 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
22318 passed through untranslated.
22320 @findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22321 @findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22322 @item PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22323 The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
22325 @findex PARAM_FILENAME
22326 @findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
22327 @item PARAM_FILENAME
22328 The value is a filename. This is just like
22329 @code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
22331 @findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
22332 @findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
22333 @item PARAM_ZINTEGER
22334 The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
22335 is interpreted as itself.
22338 @findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
22340 The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
22341 constants provided when the parameter is created.
22344 @node Functions In Python
22345 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
22347 @cindex writing convenience functions
22348 @cindex convenience functions in python
22349 @cindex python convenience functions
22350 @tindex gdb.Function
22352 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
22353 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
22354 class @code{gdb.Function}.
22356 @defmethod Function __init__ name
22357 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
22358 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
22359 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
22360 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
22361 the given @var{name}.
22363 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
22364 string for the new class.
22367 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
22368 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
22369 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
22370 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
22371 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
22372 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
22373 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
22374 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
22376 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
22377 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
22378 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
22381 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
22382 be implemented in Python:
22385 class Greet (gdb.Function):
22386 """Return string to greet someone.
22387 Takes a name as argument."""
22389 def __init__ (self):
22390 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
22392 def invoke (self, name):
22393 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
22398 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
22399 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
22400 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
22401 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
22403 @node Progspaces In Python
22404 @subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
22406 @cindex progspaces in python
22407 @tindex gdb.Progspace
22409 A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
22410 of an address space.
22411 It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
22412 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22413 @xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
22414 about program spaces.
22416 The following progspace-related functions are available in the
22419 @findex gdb.current_progspace
22420 @defun current_progspace
22421 This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
22422 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
22425 @findex gdb.progspaces
22427 Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
22430 Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
22433 @defivar Progspace filename
22434 The file name of the progspace as a string.
22437 @defivar Progspace pretty_printers
22438 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
22439 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
22440 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
22441 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
22442 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
22446 @node Objfiles In Python
22447 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
22449 @cindex objfiles in python
22450 @tindex gdb.Objfile
22452 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
22453 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
22454 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
22455 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
22456 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
22458 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
22461 @findex gdb.current_objfile
22462 @defun current_objfile
22463 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
22464 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
22465 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
22466 this function returns @code{None}.
22469 @findex gdb.objfiles
22471 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
22472 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22475 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
22478 @defivar Objfile filename
22479 The file name of the objfile as a string.
22482 @defivar Objfile pretty_printers
22483 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
22484 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
22485 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
22486 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
22487 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
22491 @node Frames In Python
22492 @subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
22494 @cindex frames in python
22495 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
22496 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
22497 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
22498 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
22499 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{gdb.error}
22500 exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
22502 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
22506 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
22510 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
22512 @findex gdb.selected_frame
22513 @defun selected_frame
22514 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
22517 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
22518 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
22519 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
22520 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
22523 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
22526 @defmethod Frame is_valid
22527 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
22528 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
22529 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
22530 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
22533 @defmethod Frame name
22534 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
22538 @defmethod Frame type
22539 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of
22540 @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, @code{gdb.DUMMY_FRAME}, @code{gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME}
22541 or @code{gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME}.
22544 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
22545 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
22546 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
22547 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
22548 function to a string.
22551 @defmethod Frame pc
22552 Returns the frame's resume address.
22555 @defmethod Frame block
22556 Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
22559 @defmethod Frame function
22560 Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
22561 @xref{Symbols In Python}.
22564 @defmethod Frame older
22565 Return the frame that called this frame.
22568 @defmethod Frame newer
22569 Return the frame called by this frame.
22572 @defmethod Frame find_sal
22573 Return the frame's symtab and line object.
22574 @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
22577 @defmethod Frame read_var variable @r{[}block@r{]}
22578 Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
22579 argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
22580 block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
22581 determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
22582 must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
22583 @code{gdb.Block} object.
22586 @defmethod Frame select
22587 Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
22592 @node Blocks In Python
22593 @subsubsection Accessing frame blocks from Python.
22595 @cindex blocks in python
22598 Within each frame, @value{GDBN} maintains information on each block
22599 stored in that frame. These blocks are organized hierarchically, and
22600 are represented individually in Python as a @code{gdb.Block}.
22601 Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more in-depth discussion on
22602 frames. Furthermore, see @ref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}, for more
22603 detailed technical information on @value{GDBN}'s book-keeping of the
22606 The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22609 @findex gdb.block_for_pc
22610 @defun block_for_pc pc
22611 Return the @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc} value. If the
22612 block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified, the function
22613 will return @code{None}.
22616 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
22619 @defivar Block start
22620 The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
22624 The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
22627 @defivar Block function
22628 The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
22629 block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
22630 attribute is not writable.
22633 @defivar Block superblock
22634 The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
22635 this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
22639 @node Symbols In Python
22640 @subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
22642 @cindex symbols in python
22645 @value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
22646 entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
22647 Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
22648 @code{gdb.Symbol} object.
22650 The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22653 @findex gdb.lookup_symbol
22654 @defun lookup_symbol name [block] [domain]
22655 This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
22656 restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
22659 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
22660 optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
22661 in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
22662 @code{gdb.Block} object. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
22663 the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
22664 domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
22668 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
22671 @defivar Symbol symtab
22672 The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
22673 represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
22674 Python}. This attribute is not writable.
22677 @defivar Symbol name
22678 The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
22681 @defivar Symbol linkage_name
22682 The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
22683 This attribute is not writable.
22686 @defivar Symbol print_name
22687 The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
22688 @code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
22689 asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
22692 @defivar Symbol addr_class
22693 The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
22694 of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
22695 @code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
22698 @defivar Symbol is_argument
22699 @code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
22702 @defivar Symbol is_constant
22703 @code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
22706 @defivar Symbol is_function
22707 @code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
22710 @defivar Symbol is_variable
22711 @code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
22715 The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
22716 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
22719 @findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22720 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22721 @item SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22722 This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
22723 following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
22724 in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
22725 @findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22726 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22727 @item SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22728 This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
22730 @findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22731 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22732 @item SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22733 This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
22734 @findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22735 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22736 @item SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22737 This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
22738 @findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22739 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22740 @item SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22741 This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
22742 contains everything minus functions and types.
22743 @findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
22744 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
22745 @item SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
22746 This domain contains all functions.
22747 @findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22748 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22749 @item SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22750 This domain contains all types.
22753 The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
22754 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
22757 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22758 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22759 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22760 If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
22761 the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
22762 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22763 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22764 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22765 Value is constant int.
22766 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22767 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22768 @item SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22769 Value is at a fixed address.
22770 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22771 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22772 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22773 Value is in a register.
22774 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22775 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22776 @item SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22777 Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
22778 symbol inside the frame's argument list.
22779 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22780 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22781 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22782 Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
22783 @code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
22784 offset, not the value itself.
22785 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22786 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22787 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22788 Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
22789 the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
22791 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22792 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22793 @item SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22794 Value is a local variable.
22795 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22796 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22797 @item SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22798 Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
22800 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22801 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22802 @item SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22804 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22805 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22806 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22807 Value is a byte-sequence.
22808 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22809 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22810 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22811 Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
22812 determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
22814 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22815 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22816 @item SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22817 The value does not actually exist in the program.
22818 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22819 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22820 @item SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22821 The value's address is a computed location.
22824 @node Symbol Tables In Python
22825 @subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
22827 @cindex symbol tables in python
22829 @tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
22831 Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
22832 is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
22833 @code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
22834 from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
22835 @xref{Frames In Python}.
22837 For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
22838 @ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
22840 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
22843 @defivar Symtab_and_line symtab
22844 The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
22845 This attribute is not writable.
22848 @defivar Symtab_and_line pc
22849 Indicates the current program counter address. This attribute is not
22853 @defivar Symtab_and_line line
22854 Indicates the current line number for this object. This
22855 attribute is not writable.
22859 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
22862 @defivar Symtab filename
22863 The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
22866 @defivar Symtab objfile
22867 The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22868 This attribute is not writable.
22872 The following methods are provided:
22875 @defmethod Symtab fullname
22876 Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
22880 @node Breakpoints In Python
22881 @subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
22883 @cindex breakpoints in python
22884 @tindex gdb.Breakpoint
22886 Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
22889 @defmethod Breakpoint __init__ spec @r{[}type@r{]} @r{[}wp_class@r{]} @r{[}internal@r{]}
22890 Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the
22891 location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a
22892 watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the
22893 @code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch}
22894 command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create
22895 from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be
22896 either: @code{BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
22897 defaults to @code{BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{internal} argument
22898 allows the breakpoint to become invisible to the user. The breakpoint
22899 will neither be reported when created, nor will it be listed in the
22900 output from @code{info breakpoints} (but will be listed with the
22901 @code{maint info breakpoints} command). The optional @var{wp_class}
22902 argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
22903 @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not provided, it is
22904 assumed to be a @var{WP_WRITE} class.
22907 The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
22912 @findex gdb.WP_READ
22914 Read only watchpoint.
22917 @findex gdb.WP_WRITE
22919 Write only watchpoint.
22922 @findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
22924 Read/Write watchpoint.
22927 @defmethod Breakpoint is_valid
22928 Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
22929 @code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
22930 if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
22931 exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
22932 watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
22933 inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
22936 @defmethod Breakpoint delete
22937 Permanently deletes the @value{GDBN} breakpoint. This also
22938 invalidates the Python @code{Breakpoint} object. Any further access
22939 to this object's attributes or methods will raise an error.
22942 @defivar Breakpoint enabled
22943 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
22944 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
22947 @defivar Breakpoint silent
22948 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
22949 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
22951 Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
22952 first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
22953 @code{silent} attribute.
22956 @defivar Breakpoint thread
22957 If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
22958 id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
22959 @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
22962 @defivar Breakpoint task
22963 If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
22964 id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
22965 language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
22969 @defivar Breakpoint ignore_count
22970 This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
22971 This attribute is writable.
22974 @defivar Breakpoint number
22975 This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
22976 the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
22979 @defivar Breakpoint type
22980 This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
22981 determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
22985 @defivar Breakpoint visible
22986 This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user
22987 when set, or when the @samp{info breakpoints} command is run. This
22988 attribute is not writable.
22991 The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
22995 @findex BP_BREAKPOINT
22996 @findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
22997 @item BP_BREAKPOINT
22998 Normal code breakpoint.
23000 @findex BP_WATCHPOINT
23001 @findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
23002 @item BP_WATCHPOINT
23003 Watchpoint breakpoint.
23005 @findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
23006 @findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
23007 @item BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
23008 Hardware assisted watchpoint.
23010 @findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
23011 @findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
23012 @item BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
23013 Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
23015 @findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
23016 @findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
23017 @item BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
23018 Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
23021 @defivar Breakpoint hit_count
23022 This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
23023 This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
23026 @defivar Breakpoint location
23027 This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
23028 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
23029 (that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
23030 attribute is not writable.
23033 @defivar Breakpoint expression
23034 This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
23035 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
23036 expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
23037 is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
23040 @defivar Breakpoint condition
23041 This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
23042 the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
23043 value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
23046 @defivar Breakpoint commands
23047 This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
23048 there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
23049 commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
23050 attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
23053 @node Lazy Strings In Python
23054 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
23056 @cindex lazy strings in python
23057 @tindex gdb.LazyString
23059 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
23060 encoded until it is needed.
23062 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
23063 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
23064 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
23065 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
23066 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
23067 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
23068 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
23069 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
23070 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
23072 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
23074 @defmethod LazyString value
23075 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
23076 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
23077 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
23078 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
23081 @defivar LazyString address
23082 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
23086 @defivar LazyString length
23087 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
23088 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
23089 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
23092 @defivar LazyString encoding
23093 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
23094 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
23095 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
23096 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
23100 @defivar LazyString type
23101 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
23102 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
23103 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
23104 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
23109 @subsection Auto-loading
23110 @cindex auto-loading, Python
23112 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23113 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23114 @value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
23115 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
23118 * objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
23119 * .debug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23120 * Which flavor to choose?::
23123 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23124 debugging commands and scripts.
23126 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled.
23129 @kindex set auto-load-scripts
23130 @item set auto-load-scripts [yes|no]
23131 Enable or disable the auto-loading of Python scripts.
23133 @kindex show auto-load-scripts
23134 @item show auto-load-scripts
23135 Show whether auto-loading of Python scripts is enabled or disabled.
23138 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
23139 @dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
23140 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
23141 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
23143 @node objfile-gdb.py file
23144 @subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
23145 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23147 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for
23148 a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
23149 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
23150 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
23151 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
23152 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
23154 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
23155 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
23156 then @value{GDBN} will look for @var{real-name} in all of the
23157 directories mentioned in the value of @code{debug-file-directory}.
23159 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23160 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
23161 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
23162 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
23163 is the object file's real name, as described above.
23165 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23166 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23167 @var{objfile} is opened.
23168 So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23169 is evaluated more than once.
23171 @node .debug_gdb_scripts section
23172 @subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23173 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23175 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23176 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23177 it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23178 If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load.
23180 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23181 current directory and then along the source search path
23182 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23183 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23184 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23186 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23187 for example, this GCC macro:
23190 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23191 #define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23193 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23195 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23201 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23204 DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23207 The script name may include directories if desired.
23209 If the macro is put in a header, any application or library
23210 using this header will get a reference to the specified script.
23212 @node Which flavor to choose?
23213 @subsubsection Which flavor to choose?
23215 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always
23216 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23218 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way:
23222 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23225 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23227 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23228 in the source search path.
23229 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23230 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23233 Doesn't require source code additions.
23236 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23240 Works with static linking.
23242 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to
23243 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23244 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23245 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script.
23248 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23250 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23251 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to.
23254 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23256 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23257 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23258 @file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23259 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23260 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23261 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23264 @node Python modules
23265 @subsection Python modules
23266 @cindex python modules
23268 @value{GDBN} comes with a module to assist writing Python code.
23271 * gdb.printing:: Building and registering pretty-printers.
23272 * gdb.types:: Utilities for working with types.
23276 @subsubsection gdb.printing
23277 @cindex gdb.printing
23279 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
23283 @item PrettyPrinter (@var{name}, @var{subprinters}=None)
23284 This class specifies the API that makes @samp{info pretty-printer},
23285 @samp{enable pretty-printer} and @samp{disable pretty-printer} work.
23286 Pretty-printers should generally inherit from this class.
23288 @item SubPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
23289 For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the
23290 corresponding API for the subprinters.
23292 @item RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
23293 Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via
23294 regular expressions.
23295 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for an example.
23297 @item register_pretty_printer (@var{obj}, @var{printer})
23298 Register @var{printer} with the pretty-printer list of @var{obj}.
23302 @subsubsection gdb.types
23305 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
23306 @code{gdb.Types} objects.
23309 @item get_basic_type (@var{type})
23310 Return @var{type} with const and volatile qualifiers stripped,
23311 and with typedefs and C@t{++} references converted to the underlying type.
23316 typedef const int const_int;
23318 const_int& foo_ref (foo);
23319 int main () @{ return 0; @}
23326 (gdb) python import gdb.types
23327 (gdb) python foo_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo_ref")
23328 (gdb) python print gdb.types.get_basic_type(foo_ref.type)
23332 @item has_field (@var{type}, @var{field})
23333 Return @code{True} if @var{type}, assumed to be a type with fields
23334 (e.g., a structure or union), has field @var{field}.
23336 @item make_enum_dict (@var{enum_type})
23337 Return a Python @code{dictionary} type produced from @var{enum_type}.
23341 @chapter Command Interpreters
23342 @cindex command interpreters
23344 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23345 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23346 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23348 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23349 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23350 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23351 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23353 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23354 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23355 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23356 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23360 @cindex console interpreter
23361 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23362 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23363 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23366 @cindex mi interpreter
23367 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23368 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23369 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23373 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23374 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23377 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23378 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23382 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23383 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23384 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23385 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23386 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23387 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
23388 the IDE inoperable!
23390 @kindex interpreter-exec
23391 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
23392 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
23393 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
23394 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
23397 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
23400 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
23401 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
23404 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
23406 @cindex Text User Interface
23409 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
23410 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
23411 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
23412 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
23413 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
23416 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
23417 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
23418 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
23419 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
23420 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
23423 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
23424 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
23425 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
23426 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
23427 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
23428 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
23431 @section TUI Overview
23433 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
23437 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
23438 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
23439 managed using readline.
23442 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
23443 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
23446 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
23449 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
23450 when their values change.
23453 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
23454 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
23455 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
23456 indicates the breakpoint type:
23460 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23463 Breakpoint which was never hit.
23466 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23469 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
23472 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
23476 Breakpoint is enabled.
23479 Breakpoint is disabled.
23482 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
23483 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
23486 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
23487 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
23498 source and assembly,
23501 source and registers, or
23504 assembly and registers.
23507 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
23511 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
23512 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
23515 Gives the current process or thread number.
23516 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
23519 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
23520 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
23521 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
23522 the string @code{??} is displayed.
23525 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
23526 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
23529 Indicates the current program counter address.
23533 @section TUI Key Bindings
23534 @cindex TUI key bindings
23536 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
23537 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23538 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
23540 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23541 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
23543 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
23544 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
23553 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
23554 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
23555 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
23556 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
23557 The screen is then refreshed.
23561 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
23562 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
23563 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
23565 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
23569 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
23570 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
23571 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
23572 previous layout and the new one.
23574 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
23578 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
23579 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
23580 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
23582 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
23586 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
23587 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
23590 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
23595 Scroll the active window one page up.
23599 Scroll the active window one page down.
23603 Scroll the active window one line up.
23607 Scroll the active window one line down.
23611 Scroll the active window one column left.
23615 Scroll the active window one column right.
23619 Refresh the screen.
23622 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
23623 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
23624 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
23625 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
23626 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
23628 @node TUI Single Key Mode
23629 @section TUI Single Key Mode
23630 @cindex TUI single key mode
23632 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
23633 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
23634 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
23637 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23641 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23645 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23649 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23653 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23655 exit the SingleKey mode.
23657 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23661 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23665 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23669 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23673 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23678 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
23679 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
23680 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
23681 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
23682 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
23683 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
23687 @section TUI-specific Commands
23688 @cindex TUI commands
23690 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
23691 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
23692 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
23693 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
23695 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
23696 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
23697 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
23698 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
23699 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
23704 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
23708 Display the next layout.
23711 Display the previous layout.
23714 Display the source window only.
23717 Display the assembly window only.
23720 Display the source and assembly window.
23723 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
23727 Make the next window active for scrolling.
23730 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
23733 Make the source window active for scrolling.
23736 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
23739 Make the register window active for scrolling.
23742 Make the command window active for scrolling.
23746 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
23748 @item tui reg float
23750 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
23752 @item tui reg general
23753 Show the general registers in the register window.
23756 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
23757 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
23758 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
23759 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
23761 @item tui reg system
23762 Show the system registers in the register window.
23766 Update the source window and the current execution point.
23768 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
23769 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
23771 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
23772 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
23775 @item tabset @var{nchars}
23777 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
23780 @node TUI Configuration
23781 @section TUI Configuration Variables
23782 @cindex TUI configuration variables
23784 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
23787 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
23788 @kindex set tui border-kind
23789 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
23790 The possible values are the following:
23793 Use a space character to draw the border.
23796 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
23799 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
23800 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
23803 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
23804 @kindex set tui border-mode
23805 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
23806 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
23807 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
23808 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
23811 Use normal attributes to display the border.
23817 Use reverse video mode.
23820 Use half bright mode.
23822 @item half-standout
23823 Use half bright and standout mode.
23826 Use extra bright or bold mode.
23828 @item bold-standout
23829 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
23834 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
23837 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
23838 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
23839 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
23842 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
23843 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
23844 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
23845 created Emacs buffer.
23846 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
23848 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
23853 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
23856 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
23857 and output done by the program you are debugging.
23859 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
23860 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
23863 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
23864 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
23865 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
23869 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
23871 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
23872 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
23873 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
23874 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
23877 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
23878 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
23881 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
23882 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
23883 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
23884 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
23886 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
23887 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
23888 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
23889 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
23890 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
23891 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
23892 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
23893 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
23894 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
23896 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
23897 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
23898 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
23899 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23901 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
23902 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
23903 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
23904 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
23907 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
23908 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
23912 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
23915 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
23916 update the display window to show the current file and location.
23919 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
23920 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
23921 to show the current file and location.
23924 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
23925 display window accordingly.
23928 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
23929 @code{finish} command.
23932 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
23936 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
23937 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
23938 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
23941 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
23942 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
23945 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
23946 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
23948 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
23949 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
23950 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
23951 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
23952 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
23953 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
23954 speedbar displays watch expressions.
23956 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
23957 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
23958 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
23959 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
23962 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
23963 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
23964 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
23965 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
23966 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
23967 to correspond properly with the code.
23969 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
23970 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
23973 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
23974 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
23976 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
23980 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
23981 called the @code{epoch}
23982 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
23983 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
23984 each value is printed in its own window.
23989 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
23991 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
23993 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
23994 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
23995 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
23996 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
23997 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
23998 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
24000 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
24001 in the form of a reference manual.
24003 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
24004 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
24005 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
24007 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
24009 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
24010 This chapter uses the following notation:
24014 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
24017 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
24018 it may or may not be given.
24021 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24022 may repeat zero or more times.
24025 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24026 may repeat one or more times.
24029 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24033 @heading Dependencies
24037 * GDB/MI General Design::
24038 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24039 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24040 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24041 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24042 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24043 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24044 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24045 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24046 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24047 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24048 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24049 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24050 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24051 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24052 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24053 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24055 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24056 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24057 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24059 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24060 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24061 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24064 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24065 @node GDB/MI General Design
24066 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24067 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24069 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24070 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24071 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24072 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24073 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24074 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24075 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24076 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24077 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24078 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24080 The important examples of notifications are:
24084 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24085 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24086 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24087 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24088 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24089 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24090 command itself was successfully executed.
24093 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24094 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24095 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24096 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24097 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24098 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24101 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24102 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24103 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24104 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24105 orthogonal frontend design.
24109 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24110 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24111 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24112 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24113 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24114 the user interface.
24118 * Context management::
24119 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24123 @node Context management
24124 @subsection Context management
24126 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24127 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24128 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24129 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24130 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24131 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24132 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24133 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24134 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24136 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24137 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24138 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24139 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24140 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24141 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24142 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24143 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24144 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24145 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24146 for thread and frame to operate on.
24148 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24149 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24150 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24151 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24152 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24153 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24154 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24155 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24156 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24157 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24159 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24160 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24161 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24162 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24163 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24164 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24165 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24166 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24167 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24168 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24169 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24170 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24171 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24172 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24173 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24174 @samp{--frame} options.
24176 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24177 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24179 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24180 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24181 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24182 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24183 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24184 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24185 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24186 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24187 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24189 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24190 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24191 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24192 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24193 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24196 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24197 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24198 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24199 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24200 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24201 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24202 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24203 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24204 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24205 @samp{--thread} option).
24207 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24208 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24209 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24210 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24212 @node Thread groups
24213 @subsection Thread groups
24214 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24215 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24216 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24217 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24218 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24220 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24221 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24222 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24223 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24224 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24225 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24226 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24229 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24230 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24231 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24232 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24233 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24234 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24235 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24236 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24237 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24238 the members of specific thread group.
24240 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24241 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24242 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24243 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24244 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24245 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24246 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24247 after attaching to that thread group.
24249 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24250 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24251 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24252 such thread groups.
24254 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24255 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24256 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24259 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24260 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24263 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24264 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24266 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24267 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24269 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24270 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24272 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24273 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24274 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24276 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24277 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24278 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24280 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24281 "any sequence of digits"
24283 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24284 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24286 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24287 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24289 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24290 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24292 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24293 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24294 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24296 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24297 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24299 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24308 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24309 output is described below.
24312 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24316 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24317 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24318 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24319 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24320 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24327 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24330 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24333 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24334 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24336 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24337 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24338 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24339 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24340 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24341 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24343 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24344 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24348 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24349 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24351 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24352 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24354 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
24355 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
24357 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
24358 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
24360 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
24361 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
24363 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
24364 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
24366 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
24367 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
24369 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
24370 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24372 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
24373 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
24375 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
24376 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
24377 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
24379 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
24380 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
24382 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
24383 @code{ @var{string} }
24385 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
24386 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
24388 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
24389 @code{@var{c-string}}
24391 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
24392 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
24394 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
24395 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
24396 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
24398 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
24399 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
24401 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
24402 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
24404 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
24405 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
24407 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
24408 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
24410 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24413 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24414 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
24422 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
24425 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
24426 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
24427 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
24428 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
24429 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
24430 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
24434 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24435 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
24436 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
24437 prefixed by @samp{+}.
24440 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24441 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
24442 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
24446 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24447 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
24448 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
24449 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
24452 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24453 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
24454 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
24455 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
24458 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24459 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
24460 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
24463 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24464 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
24465 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
24466 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
24469 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24470 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
24476 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
24477 details about the various output records.
24479 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24480 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
24481 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
24483 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
24484 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
24486 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
24487 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
24488 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
24489 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
24490 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
24491 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
24493 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
24494 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
24495 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
24497 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24498 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
24499 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
24500 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
24502 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
24503 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
24505 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
24506 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
24507 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
24508 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
24511 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
24512 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
24513 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
24514 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
24518 New MI commands may be added.
24521 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
24524 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
24525 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
24527 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
24528 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
24530 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
24531 @c resolve inconsistencies.
24534 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
24535 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
24536 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
24537 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
24538 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
24540 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
24543 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
24544 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
24545 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
24546 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
24547 @cindex mailing lists
24549 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24550 @node GDB/MI Output Records
24551 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
24554 * GDB/MI Result Records::
24555 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
24556 * GDB/MI Async Records::
24557 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
24558 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
24561 @node GDB/MI Result Records
24562 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
24564 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24565 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
24566 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
24567 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
24571 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
24572 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
24577 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
24578 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
24579 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
24580 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
24581 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
24582 which threads are resumed.
24586 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
24588 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
24590 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
24595 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
24599 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
24600 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
24602 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
24603 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24604 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
24605 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
24606 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
24608 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
24609 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
24610 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
24611 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
24612 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
24615 @item "~" @var{string-output}
24616 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
24617 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
24619 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
24620 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
24621 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
24622 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
24624 @item "&" @var{string-output}
24625 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
24629 @node GDB/MI Async Records
24630 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
24632 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24633 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
24634 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
24635 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
24636 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
24637 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
24639 The following is the list of possible async records:
24643 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
24644 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
24645 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
24646 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
24647 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
24648 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
24649 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
24650 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
24651 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
24652 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
24654 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
24655 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
24659 @item breakpoint-hit
24660 A breakpoint was reached.
24661 @item watchpoint-trigger
24662 A watchpoint was triggered.
24663 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
24664 A read watchpoint was triggered.
24665 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
24666 An access watchpoint was triggered.
24667 @item function-finished
24668 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
24669 @item location-reached
24670 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
24671 @item watchpoint-scope
24672 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
24673 @item end-stepping-range
24674 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
24675 similar CLI command was accomplished.
24676 @item exited-signalled
24677 The inferior exited because of a signal.
24679 The inferior exited.
24680 @item exited-normally
24681 The inferior exited normally.
24682 @item signal-received
24683 A signal was received by the inferior.
24686 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
24687 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
24688 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
24689 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
24690 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
24691 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
24692 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
24693 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
24694 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
24695 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
24696 if such information is not available.
24698 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
24699 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
24700 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
24701 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
24702 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
24703 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
24704 cannot be used in any way.
24706 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
24707 A thread group became associated with a running program,
24708 either because the program was just started or the thread group
24709 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
24710 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
24711 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
24713 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
24714 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
24715 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
24716 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
24719 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
24720 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
24721 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
24722 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
24723 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
24725 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
24726 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
24727 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
24728 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
24729 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
24730 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
24731 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
24733 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
24734 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
24737 @item =library-loaded,...
24738 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
24739 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
24740 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
24741 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
24742 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
24743 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
24744 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
24745 @var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
24746 library are loaded. The @var{thread-group} field, if present,
24747 specifies the id of the thread group in whose context the library was loaded.
24748 If the field is absent, it means the library was loaded in the context
24749 of all present thread groups.
24751 @item =library-unloaded,...
24752 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
24753 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
24754 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
24755 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
24756 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
24757 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
24762 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
24763 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
24765 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
24766 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
24771 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
24772 zero. This field is always present.
24775 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
24776 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
24779 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
24782 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
24783 address. This field may be absent.
24786 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
24790 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
24791 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
24795 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
24796 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
24798 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
24799 uses a tuple with the following fields:
24803 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
24807 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
24810 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
24811 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
24812 frontend. This field is optional.
24815 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
24816 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
24819 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
24820 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
24824 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24825 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
24826 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
24827 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
24829 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
24830 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
24831 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
24832 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
24834 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
24835 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
24837 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
24839 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
24840 information of the breakpoint.
24843 -> -break-insert main
24844 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
24845 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
24846 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
24850 @subheading Program Execution
24852 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
24853 reason that execution stopped.
24859 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
24860 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
24861 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
24862 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
24867 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
24871 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
24873 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
24881 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
24882 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
24883 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
24884 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
24885 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
24886 fails to exit in reasonable time.
24888 @subheading A Bad Command
24890 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
24894 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
24899 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24900 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
24901 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
24903 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
24904 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
24906 @subheading Motivation
24908 The motivation for this collection of commands.
24910 @subheading Introduction
24912 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
24914 @subheading Commands
24916 For each command in the block, the following is described:
24918 @subsubheading Synopsis
24921 -command @var{args}@dots{}
24924 @subsubheading Result
24926 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24928 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
24930 @subsubheading Example
24932 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
24933 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
24936 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24937 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
24938 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
24940 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
24941 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
24942 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
24945 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
24946 @findex -break-after
24948 @subsubheading Synopsis
24951 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
24954 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
24955 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
24956 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
24957 @samp{-break-list} command below.
24959 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24961 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
24963 @subsubheading Example
24968 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
24969 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
24970 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
24977 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
24978 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24979 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24980 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24981 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24982 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24983 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24984 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24985 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
24986 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
24991 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
24992 @findex -break-catch
24995 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
24996 @findex -break-commands
24998 @subsubheading Synopsis
25001 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
25004 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
25005 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
25006 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
25007 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
25008 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
25009 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
25011 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25013 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
25015 @subsubheading Example
25020 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25021 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25022 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
25024 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
25029 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25030 @findex -break-condition
25032 @subsubheading Synopsis
25035 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25038 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25039 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25040 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25045 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25047 @subsubheading Example
25051 -break-condition 1 1
25055 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25056 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25057 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25058 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25059 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25060 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25061 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25062 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25063 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25064 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25068 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25069 @findex -break-delete
25071 @subsubheading Synopsis
25074 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25077 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25078 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25080 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25082 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25084 @subsubheading Example
25092 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25093 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25094 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25095 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25096 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25097 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25098 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25103 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25104 @findex -break-disable
25106 @subsubheading Synopsis
25109 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25112 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25113 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25115 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25117 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25119 @subsubheading Example
25127 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25128 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25129 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25130 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25131 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25132 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25133 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25134 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
25135 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25136 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
25140 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
25141 @findex -break-enable
25143 @subsubheading Synopsis
25146 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25149 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
25151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25153 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
25155 @subsubheading Example
25163 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25164 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25165 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25166 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25167 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25168 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25169 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25170 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25171 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25172 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
25176 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
25177 @findex -break-info
25179 @subsubheading Synopsis
25182 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
25186 Get information about a single breakpoint.
25188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
25192 @subsubheading Example
25195 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
25196 @findex -break-insert
25198 @subsubheading Synopsis
25201 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
25202 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
25203 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
25207 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
25214 @item filename:linenum
25215 @item filename:function
25219 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
25223 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
25225 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
25226 @item -c @var{condition}
25227 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
25228 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
25229 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
25231 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
25232 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
25233 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
25234 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
25237 Create a disabled breakpoint.
25239 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
25240 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
25243 @subsubheading Result
25245 The result is in the form:
25248 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
25249 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
25250 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
25251 times="@var{times}"@}
25255 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
25256 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
25257 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
25258 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
25259 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
25260 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
25261 which use the same output).
25263 Note: this format is open to change.
25264 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
25266 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25268 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
25269 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
25271 @subsubheading Example
25276 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
25277 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
25279 -break-insert -t foo
25280 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
25281 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
25284 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25285 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25286 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25287 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25288 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25289 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25290 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25291 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25292 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
25293 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
25294 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
25295 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
25296 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
25298 -break-insert -r foo.*
25299 ~int foo(int, int);
25300 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
25301 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
25305 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
25306 @findex -break-list
25308 @subsubheading Synopsis
25314 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
25318 number of the breakpoint
25320 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
25322 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
25325 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
25327 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
25329 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
25332 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
25335 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
25336 @code{body} field is an empty list.
25338 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25340 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
25342 @subsubheading Example
25347 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25348 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25349 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25350 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25351 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25352 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25353 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25354 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25355 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
25356 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25357 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25358 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
25362 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
25367 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25368 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25369 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25370 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25371 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25372 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25373 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25378 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
25379 @findex -break-passcount
25381 @subsubheading Synopsis
25384 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
25387 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
25388 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
25389 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
25390 command @samp{passcount}.
25392 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
25393 @findex -break-watch
25395 @subsubheading Synopsis
25398 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
25401 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
25402 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
25403 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
25404 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
25405 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
25406 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
25407 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
25408 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
25410 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
25411 breakpoints inserted.
25413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25415 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
25418 @subsubheading Example
25420 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
25425 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
25430 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
25431 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
25432 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
25433 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
25437 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
25438 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
25439 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
25444 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
25449 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
25450 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
25451 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
25452 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25453 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
25458 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
25459 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
25460 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
25461 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25462 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
25466 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
25467 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
25473 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
25476 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25477 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25478 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25479 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25480 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25481 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25482 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25483 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25484 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25485 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25486 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
25487 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
25488 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
25493 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
25494 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
25495 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
25496 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25497 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
25500 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25501 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25502 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25503 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25504 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25505 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25506 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25507 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25508 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25509 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25510 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
25511 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
25512 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
25516 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
25517 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
25518 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
25519 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25520 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
25523 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25524 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25525 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25526 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25527 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25528 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25529 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25530 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25531 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25532 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25533 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
25538 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25539 @node GDB/MI Program Context
25540 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
25542 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
25543 @findex -exec-arguments
25546 @subsubheading Synopsis
25549 -exec-arguments @var{args}
25552 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
25555 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25557 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
25559 @subsubheading Example
25563 -exec-arguments -v word
25570 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
25571 @findex -exec-show-arguments
25573 @subsubheading Synopsis
25576 -exec-show-arguments
25579 Print the arguments of the program.
25581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25583 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
25585 @subsubheading Example
25590 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
25591 @findex -environment-cd
25593 @subsubheading Synopsis
25596 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
25599 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
25601 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25603 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
25605 @subsubheading Example
25609 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
25615 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
25616 @findex -environment-directory
25618 @subsubheading Synopsis
25621 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
25624 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
25625 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
25626 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
25627 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
25629 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
25630 multiple directories in a single command
25631 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
25632 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
25633 If blanks are needed as
25634 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
25635 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
25636 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
25637 character must not be used
25638 in any directory name.
25639 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
25641 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25643 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
25645 @subsubheading Example
25649 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
25650 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
25652 -environment-directory ""
25653 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
25655 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
25656 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
25658 -environment-directory -r
25659 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
25664 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
25665 @findex -environment-path
25667 @subsubheading Synopsis
25670 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
25673 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
25674 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
25675 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
25676 supplied in addition to the
25677 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
25679 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
25680 multiple directories in a single command
25681 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
25682 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
25683 If blanks are needed as
25684 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
25685 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
25686 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
25687 character must not be used
25688 in any directory name.
25689 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
25692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25694 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
25696 @subsubheading Example
25701 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
25703 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
25704 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
25706 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
25707 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
25712 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
25713 @findex -environment-pwd
25715 @subsubheading Synopsis
25721 Show the current working directory.
25723 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25725 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
25727 @subsubheading Example
25732 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
25736 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25737 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
25738 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
25741 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
25742 @findex -thread-info
25744 @subsubheading Synopsis
25747 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
25750 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
25751 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
25752 threads. When printing information about all threads,
25753 also reports the current thread.
25755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25757 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
25760 @subsubheading Example
25765 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
25766 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
25767 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
25768 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
25769 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
25770 current-thread-id="1"
25774 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
25778 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
25782 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
25787 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
25788 @findex -thread-list-ids
25790 @subsubheading Synopsis
25796 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
25797 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
25799 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
25800 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
25802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25804 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
25806 @subsubheading Example
25811 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
25812 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
25817 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
25818 @findex -thread-select
25820 @subsubheading Synopsis
25823 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
25826 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
25827 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
25829 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
25830 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
25832 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25834 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
25836 @subsubheading Example
25843 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
25844 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
25848 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
25849 number-of-threads="3"
25852 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
25853 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
25854 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
25855 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
25859 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25860 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
25861 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
25863 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
25864 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
25865 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
25868 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
25869 @findex -exec-continue
25871 @subsubheading Synopsis
25874 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
25877 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
25878 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
25879 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
25880 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
25883 breakpoints or watchpoints
25885 signals or exceptions
25887 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
25889 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
25891 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
25892 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
25893 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
25894 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
25895 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
25896 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
25898 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25900 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
25902 @subsubheading Example
25909 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
25910 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
25916 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
25917 @findex -exec-finish
25919 @subsubheading Synopsis
25922 -exec-finish [--reverse]
25925 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
25926 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
25927 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
25928 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
25929 function was called.
25931 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25933 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
25935 @subsubheading Example
25937 Function returning @code{void}.
25944 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
25945 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
25949 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
25950 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
25957 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
25958 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
25959 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25960 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
25965 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
25966 @findex -exec-interrupt
25968 @subsubheading Synopsis
25971 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
25974 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
25975 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
25976 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
25977 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
25978 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
25980 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
25981 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
25982 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
25983 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
25985 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
25986 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
25987 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
25988 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
25990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25992 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
25994 @subsubheading Example
26005 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
26006 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26007 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
26012 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
26016 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
26019 @subsubheading Synopsis
26022 -exec-jump @var{location}
26025 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
26026 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
26027 different forms of @var{location}.
26029 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26031 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
26033 @subsubheading Example
26036 -exec-jump foo.c:10
26037 *running,thread-id="all"
26042 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
26045 @subsubheading Synopsis
26048 -exec-next [--reverse]
26051 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
26052 of the next source line is reached.
26054 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
26055 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
26056 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
26057 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
26058 source line where the function was called.
26061 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26063 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
26065 @subsubheading Example
26071 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
26076 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
26077 @findex -exec-next-instruction
26079 @subsubheading Synopsis
26082 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
26085 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
26086 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
26087 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
26090 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
26091 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
26092 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
26093 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
26094 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
26096 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26098 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
26100 @subsubheading Example
26104 -exec-next-instruction
26108 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26109 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
26114 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
26115 @findex -exec-return
26117 @subsubheading Synopsis
26123 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
26124 Displays the new current frame.
26126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26128 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
26130 @subsubheading Example
26134 200-break-insert callee4
26135 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
26136 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
26141 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
26142 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26143 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26144 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
26150 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
26151 args=[@{name="strarg",
26152 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26153 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26154 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26159 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
26162 @subsubheading Synopsis
26165 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N]
26168 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
26169 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
26170 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
26171 the program has exited exceptionally.
26173 When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
26174 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
26175 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
26176 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
26178 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26180 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
26182 @subsubheading Examples
26187 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
26192 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
26193 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26194 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
26199 Program exited normally:
26207 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26212 Program exited exceptionally:
26220 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
26224 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
26225 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
26229 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
26230 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
26234 @c @subheading -exec-signal
26237 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
26240 @subsubheading Synopsis
26243 -exec-step [--reverse]
26246 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
26247 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
26248 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
26249 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
26250 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
26251 previously executed source line.
26253 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26255 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
26257 @subsubheading Example
26259 Stepping into a function:
26265 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26266 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
26267 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
26268 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
26278 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
26283 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
26284 @findex -exec-step-instruction
26286 @subsubheading Synopsis
26289 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
26292 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
26293 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
26294 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
26295 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
26296 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
26297 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
26300 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26302 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
26304 @subsubheading Example
26308 -exec-step-instruction
26312 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26313 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26314 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
26316 -exec-step-instruction
26320 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26321 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26322 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
26327 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
26328 @findex -exec-until
26330 @subsubheading Synopsis
26333 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
26336 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
26337 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
26338 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
26339 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
26341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
26345 @subsubheading Example
26349 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
26353 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
26354 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
26359 @subheading -file-clear
26360 Is this going away????
26363 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26364 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
26365 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
26368 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
26369 @findex -stack-info-frame
26371 @subsubheading Synopsis
26377 Get info on the selected frame.
26379 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26381 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
26382 (without arguments).
26384 @subsubheading Example
26389 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
26390 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26391 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
26395 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
26396 @findex -stack-info-depth
26398 @subsubheading Synopsis
26401 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
26404 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
26405 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
26407 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26409 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
26411 @subsubheading Example
26413 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
26420 -stack-info-depth 4
26423 -stack-info-depth 12
26426 -stack-info-depth 11
26429 -stack-info-depth 13
26434 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
26435 @findex -stack-list-arguments
26437 @subsubheading Synopsis
26440 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
26441 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
26444 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
26445 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
26446 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
26447 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
26448 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
26449 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
26450 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
26451 which case only existing frames will be returned.
26453 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26454 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26455 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26456 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26457 structures and unions.
26459 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
26460 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
26462 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26464 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
26465 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
26466 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
26468 @subsubheading Example
26475 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26476 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26477 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
26478 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
26479 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26480 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
26481 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
26482 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26483 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
26484 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
26485 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26486 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
26487 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
26488 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26489 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
26491 -stack-list-arguments 0
26494 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
26495 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
26496 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
26497 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
26498 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
26500 -stack-list-arguments 1
26503 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
26505 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
26506 frame=@{level="2",args=[
26507 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26508 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
26509 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
26510 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26511 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
26512 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
26513 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
26515 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
26516 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
26518 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
26519 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
26520 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26521 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
26525 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
26528 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
26529 @findex -stack-list-frames
26531 @subsubheading Synopsis
26534 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
26537 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
26542 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
26544 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
26548 File name of the source file where the function lives.
26549 @item @var{fullname}
26550 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
26552 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
26554 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
26555 if the frame's function is not known.
26558 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
26559 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
26560 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
26561 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
26562 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
26563 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
26564 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
26566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26568 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
26570 @subsubheading Example
26572 Full stack backtrace:
26578 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
26579 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
26580 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26581 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26582 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26583 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26584 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26585 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26586 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26587 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26588 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26589 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26590 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26591 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26592 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26593 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26594 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26595 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26596 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26597 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26598 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26599 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26600 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
26601 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
26605 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
26609 -stack-list-frames 3 5
26611 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26612 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26613 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26614 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26615 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26616 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
26620 Show a single frame:
26624 -stack-list-frames 3 3
26626 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26627 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
26632 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
26633 @findex -stack-list-locals
26635 @subsubheading Synopsis
26638 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
26641 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
26642 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26643 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26644 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26645 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26646 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
26647 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
26648 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
26651 This command is deprecated in favor of the
26652 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
26654 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26656 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
26658 @subsubheading Example
26662 -stack-list-locals 0
26663 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
26665 -stack-list-locals --all-values
26666 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
26667 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
26668 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
26669 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
26670 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
26674 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
26675 @findex -stack-list-variables
26677 @subsubheading Synopsis
26680 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
26683 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
26684 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26685 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26686 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26687 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26688 structures and unions.
26690 @subsubheading Example
26694 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
26695 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
26700 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
26701 @findex -stack-select-frame
26703 @subsubheading Synopsis
26706 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
26709 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
26712 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
26713 option to every command.
26715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26717 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
26718 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
26720 @subsubheading Example
26724 -stack-select-frame 2
26729 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26730 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
26731 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
26735 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
26737 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
26738 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
26739 used by @code{Insight}.
26741 The two main reasons for that are:
26745 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
26748 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
26752 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
26753 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
26754 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
26755 hints about their use.
26757 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
26758 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
26759 least, the following operations:
26762 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
26763 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
26764 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
26765 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
26770 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
26772 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
26774 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
26775 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
26776 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
26777 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
26778 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
26779 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
26780 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
26781 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
26782 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
26783 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
26784 object, or to change display format.
26786 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
26787 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
26788 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
26789 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
26790 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
26791 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
26792 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
26793 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
26794 child will be created.
26796 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
26797 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
26798 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
26799 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
26800 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
26802 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
26803 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
26804 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
26805 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
26806 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
26807 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
26808 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
26809 variables that frontend has created.
26811 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
26812 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
26813 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
26814 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
26815 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
26816 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
26817 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
26818 implicitly updated.
26820 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
26821 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
26822 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
26823 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
26824 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
26825 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
26826 frame. Consider this example:
26831 struct work_state state;
26838 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
26839 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
26840 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
26841 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
26842 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
26844 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
26845 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
26846 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
26847 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
26848 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
26849 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
26851 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
26852 access this functionality:
26854 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
26855 @item @strong{Operation}
26856 @tab @strong{Description}
26858 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
26859 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
26860 @item @code{-var-create}
26861 @tab create a variable object
26862 @item @code{-var-delete}
26863 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
26864 @item @code{-var-set-format}
26865 @tab set the display format of this variable
26866 @item @code{-var-show-format}
26867 @tab show the display format of this variable
26868 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
26869 @tab tells how many children this object has
26870 @item @code{-var-list-children}
26871 @tab return a list of the object's children
26872 @item @code{-var-info-type}
26873 @tab show the type of this variable object
26874 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
26875 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
26876 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
26877 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
26878 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
26879 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
26880 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
26881 @tab get the value of this variable
26882 @item @code{-var-assign}
26883 @tab set the value of this variable
26884 @item @code{-var-update}
26885 @tab update the variable and its children
26886 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
26887 @tab set frozeness attribute
26888 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
26889 @tab set range of children to display on update
26892 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
26893 how it can be used.
26895 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
26897 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
26898 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
26901 -enable-pretty-printing
26904 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
26905 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
26906 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
26907 request that this functionality be enabled.
26909 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
26911 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
26912 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
26914 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
26915 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
26917 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
26918 @findex -var-create
26920 @subsubheading Synopsis
26923 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
26924 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
26927 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
26928 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
26931 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
26932 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
26933 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
26934 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
26935 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
26937 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
26938 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
26939 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
26940 object must be created.
26942 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
26943 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
26947 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
26950 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
26953 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
26956 @cindex dynamic varobj
26957 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
26958 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
26959 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
26960 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
26961 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
26962 compatibility for existing clients.
26964 @subsubheading Result
26966 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
26971 The name of the varobj.
26974 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
26975 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
26976 @samp{has_more} attribute.
26979 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
26980 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
26981 will not be interesting.
26984 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
26985 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.
26988 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
26989 thread's identifier.
26992 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
26993 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
26996 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
26997 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
26998 then this attribute will not be present.
27001 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
27002 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
27003 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
27006 Typical output will look like this:
27009 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
27010 has_more="@var{has_more}"
27014 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
27015 @findex -var-delete
27017 @subsubheading Synopsis
27020 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
27023 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
27024 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
27026 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
27029 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
27030 @findex -var-set-format
27032 @subsubheading Synopsis
27035 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
27038 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
27041 @anchor{-var-set-format}
27042 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
27045 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
27046 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
27049 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
27050 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
27051 for pointers, etc.).
27053 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
27054 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
27056 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
27057 @findex -var-show-format
27059 @subsubheading Synopsis
27062 -var-show-format @var{name}
27065 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
27068 @var{format} @expansion{}
27073 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
27074 @findex -var-info-num-children
27076 @subsubheading Synopsis
27079 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
27082 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
27088 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
27089 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
27093 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
27094 @findex -var-list-children
27096 @subsubheading Synopsis
27099 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
27101 @anchor{-var-list-children}
27103 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
27104 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
27105 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
27106 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
27107 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
27108 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
27109 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
27112 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
27113 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
27114 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
27115 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
27118 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
27119 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
27120 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
27121 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
27122 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
27123 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
27124 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
27125 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
27128 For each child the following results are returned:
27133 Name of the variable object created for this child.
27136 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
27137 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
27139 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
27140 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
27142 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
27143 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
27144 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
27145 type and value are not present.
27147 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
27148 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
27149 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
27152 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
27156 The type of the child.
27159 If values were requested, this is the value.
27162 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
27163 Otherwise this result is not present.
27166 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
27169 The result may have its own attributes:
27173 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
27174 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
27175 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
27178 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
27179 remaining after the end of the selected range.
27182 @subsubheading Example
27186 -var-list-children n
27187 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
27188 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
27190 -var-list-children --all-values n
27191 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
27192 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
27196 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
27197 @findex -var-info-type
27199 @subsubheading Synopsis
27202 -var-info-type @var{name}
27205 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
27206 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
27210 type=@var{typename}
27214 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
27215 @findex -var-info-expression
27217 @subsubheading Synopsis
27220 -var-info-expression @var{name}
27223 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
27224 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
27225 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
27227 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
27228 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
27231 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
27232 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
27236 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
27238 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
27239 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
27242 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
27243 @findex -var-info-path-expression
27245 @subsubheading Synopsis
27248 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
27251 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
27252 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
27253 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
27254 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
27255 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
27256 watchpoint from a variable object.
27258 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
27259 and will give an error when invoked on one.
27261 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
27262 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
27263 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
27264 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
27265 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
27267 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
27268 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
27271 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
27272 @findex -var-show-attributes
27274 @subsubheading Synopsis
27277 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
27280 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
27283 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
27287 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
27289 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
27290 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
27292 @subsubheading Synopsis
27295 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
27298 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
27299 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
27300 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
27301 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
27302 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
27303 the current display format will be used. The current display format
27304 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
27310 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
27311 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
27313 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
27314 @findex -var-assign
27316 @subsubheading Synopsis
27319 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
27322 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
27323 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
27324 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
27325 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
27327 @subsubheading Example
27335 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
27339 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
27340 @findex -var-update
27342 @subsubheading Synopsis
27345 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
27348 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
27349 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
27350 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
27351 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
27352 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
27353 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
27354 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
27355 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
27356 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
27357 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
27358 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
27359 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
27360 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
27362 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
27363 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
27366 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
27367 only the selected range of children will be reported.
27369 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
27372 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
27376 The name of the varobj.
27379 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
27380 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
27383 @anchor{-var-update}
27384 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
27388 The variable object's current value is valid.
27391 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
27392 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
27396 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
27397 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
27398 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
27399 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
27403 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
27404 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
27407 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
27408 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
27412 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
27415 @item new_num_children
27416 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
27417 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
27419 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
27420 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
27421 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
27422 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
27423 children which may be available.
27425 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
27426 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
27427 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
27428 only happen at the end of the update range).
27431 The display hint, if any.
27434 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
27435 available outside the varobj's update range.
27438 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
27439 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
27440 then this attribute will not be present.
27443 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
27444 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
27445 be listed in this attribute.
27448 @subsubheading Example
27455 -var-update --all-values var1
27456 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
27457 type_changed="false"@}]
27461 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
27462 @findex -var-set-frozen
27463 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
27465 @subsubheading Synopsis
27468 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
27471 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
27472 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
27473 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
27474 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
27475 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
27476 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
27477 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
27478 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
27479 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
27480 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
27481 @code{-var-update} does.
27483 @subsubheading Example
27487 -var-set-frozen V 1
27492 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
27493 @findex -var-set-update-range
27494 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
27496 @subsubheading Synopsis
27499 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
27502 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
27503 @code{-var-update}.
27505 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
27506 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
27507 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
27508 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
27510 @subsubheading Example
27514 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
27518 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
27519 @findex -var-set-visualizer
27520 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
27522 @subsubheading Synopsis
27525 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
27528 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
27530 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
27531 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
27533 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
27534 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
27535 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
27536 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
27537 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
27538 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
27539 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
27541 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
27542 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
27543 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
27544 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
27546 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
27547 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
27548 can be used to check this.
27550 @subsubheading Example
27552 Resetting the visualizer:
27556 -var-set-visualizer V None
27560 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
27564 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
27568 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
27569 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
27573 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
27577 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27578 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
27579 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
27581 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
27582 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
27583 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
27584 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
27586 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
27587 @c @subheading -data-assign
27588 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
27589 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
27591 @c @subsubheading Example
27594 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
27595 @findex -data-disassemble
27597 @subsubheading Synopsis
27601 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
27602 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
27610 @item @var{start-addr}
27611 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
27612 @item @var{end-addr}
27614 @item @var{filename}
27615 is the name of the file to disassemble
27616 @item @var{linenum}
27617 is the line number to disassemble around
27619 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
27620 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
27621 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
27622 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
27623 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
27624 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
27625 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
27628 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
27632 @subsubheading Result
27634 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
27643 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
27644 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
27646 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27648 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
27650 @subsubheading Example
27652 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
27656 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
27659 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27660 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27661 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27662 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27663 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
27664 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
27665 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
27666 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27667 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
27668 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
27672 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
27676 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
27678 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27679 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
27680 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27681 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27682 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27683 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27685 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
27686 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
27690 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
27694 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
27696 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27697 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
27698 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27699 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27700 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27701 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
27705 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
27709 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
27711 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
27712 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
27713 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
27714 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27715 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
27716 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
27717 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
27718 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
27719 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27720 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27721 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27722 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
27727 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
27728 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
27730 @subsubheading Synopsis
27733 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
27736 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
27737 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
27738 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
27740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27742 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
27743 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
27744 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
27746 @subsubheading Example
27748 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
27749 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
27750 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
27754 211-data-evaluate-expression A
27757 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
27758 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
27760 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
27763 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
27769 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
27770 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
27772 @subsubheading Synopsis
27775 -data-list-changed-registers
27778 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
27780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27782 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
27783 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
27785 @subsubheading Example
27787 On a PPC MBX board:
27795 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
27796 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
27799 -data-list-changed-registers
27800 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
27801 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
27802 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
27807 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
27808 @findex -data-list-register-names
27810 @subsubheading Synopsis
27813 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
27816 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
27817 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
27818 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
27819 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
27820 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
27821 include empty register names.
27823 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27825 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
27826 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
27827 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
27829 @subsubheading Example
27831 For the PPC MBX board:
27834 -data-list-register-names
27835 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
27836 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
27837 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
27838 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
27839 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
27840 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
27841 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
27843 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
27844 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
27848 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
27849 @findex -data-list-register-values
27851 @subsubheading Synopsis
27854 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
27857 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
27858 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
27859 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
27860 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
27862 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
27879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
27882 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
27884 @subsubheading Example
27886 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
27887 don't appear in the actual output):
27891 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
27892 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
27893 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
27895 -data-list-register-values x
27896 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
27897 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
27898 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
27899 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
27900 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
27901 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
27902 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
27903 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
27904 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
27905 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
27906 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
27907 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
27908 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
27909 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
27910 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
27911 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
27912 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
27913 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
27914 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
27915 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
27916 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
27917 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
27918 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
27919 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
27920 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
27921 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
27922 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
27923 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
27924 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
27925 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
27926 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
27927 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
27928 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
27929 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
27930 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
27931 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
27936 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
27937 @findex -data-read-memory
27939 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
27941 @subsubheading Synopsis
27944 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
27945 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
27946 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
27953 @item @var{address}
27954 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
27955 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
27956 quoted using the C convention.
27958 @item @var{word-format}
27959 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
27960 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
27963 @item @var{word-size}
27964 The size of each memory word in bytes.
27966 @item @var{nr-rows}
27967 The number of rows in the output table.
27969 @item @var{nr-cols}
27970 The number of columns in the output table.
27973 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
27974 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
27975 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
27976 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
27978 @item @var{byte-offset}
27979 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
27982 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
27983 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
27984 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
27985 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
27986 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
27987 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
27988 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
27991 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
27992 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
27995 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27997 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
27998 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
28000 @subsubheading Example
28002 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
28003 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
28004 word. Display each word in hex.
28008 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
28009 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
28010 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
28011 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
28012 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
28013 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
28014 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
28018 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
28019 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
28023 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
28024 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
28025 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
28026 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
28027 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
28031 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
28032 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
28033 used as the non-printable character.
28037 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
28038 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
28039 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
28040 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
28041 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28042 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28043 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28044 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
28045 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
28046 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
28047 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
28048 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
28052 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
28053 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
28055 @subsubheading Synopsis
28058 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
28059 @var{address} @var{count}
28066 @item @var{address}
28067 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28068 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28069 quoted using the C convention.
28072 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
28074 @item @var{byte-offset}
28075 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
28076 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
28077 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
28078 perform address arithmetics itself.
28082 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
28083 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
28084 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
28085 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
28086 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
28087 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
28089 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
28090 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
28091 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
28092 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
28093 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
28094 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
28095 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
28096 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
28098 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
28099 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
28100 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
28101 and has the following fields:
28105 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
28108 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
28111 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
28112 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
28115 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
28121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28123 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
28125 @subsubheading Example
28129 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
28130 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
28132 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
28137 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
28138 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
28140 @subsubheading Synopsis
28143 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
28150 @item @var{address}
28151 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28152 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28153 quoted using the C convention.
28155 @item @var{contents}
28156 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
28160 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28162 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
28164 @subsubheading Example
28168 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
28174 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28175 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
28176 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
28178 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
28179 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
28181 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
28182 @findex -trace-find
28184 @subsubheading Synopsis
28187 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
28190 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
28191 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
28192 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
28197 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
28200 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
28203 @item tracepoint-number
28204 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
28205 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
28208 An address is required as parameter. Finds
28209 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
28212 @item pc-inside-range
28213 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
28214 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
28215 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
28217 @item pc-outside-range
28218 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
28219 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
28220 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
28223 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
28224 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
28225 the specified location.
28229 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
28230 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
28234 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
28235 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
28238 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
28239 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
28242 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
28243 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
28246 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
28247 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
28248 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
28252 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28254 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
28256 @subheading -trace-define-variable
28257 @findex -trace-define-variable
28259 @subsubheading Synopsis
28262 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
28265 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
28266 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
28267 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
28268 with the @samp{$} character.
28270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28272 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
28274 @subheading -trace-list-variables
28275 @findex -trace-list-variables
28277 @subsubheading Synopsis
28280 -trace-list-variables
28283 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
28284 table has the following fields:
28288 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
28291 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
28292 field is always present.
28295 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
28296 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
28297 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
28302 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28304 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
28306 @subsubheading Example
28310 -trace-list-variables
28311 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
28312 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
28313 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
28314 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
28315 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
28316 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
28320 @subheading -trace-save
28321 @findex -trace-save
28323 @subsubheading Synopsis
28326 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
28329 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
28330 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
28331 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
28332 to perform the save.
28334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
28339 @subheading -trace-start
28340 @findex -trace-start
28342 @subsubheading Synopsis
28348 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
28351 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28353 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
28355 @subheading -trace-status
28356 @findex -trace-status
28358 @subsubheading Synopsis
28364 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
28365 the following fields:
28370 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
28371 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
28372 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
28373 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
28374 started. This field is always present.
28377 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
28378 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
28379 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
28382 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
28383 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
28384 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
28385 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
28386 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
28387 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
28388 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
28389 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
28390 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
28392 @item stopping-tracepoint
28393 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
28394 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
28398 @itemx frames-created
28399 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
28400 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
28401 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
28402 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
28406 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
28407 remaining space. These fields are optional.
28410 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
28411 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
28412 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
28416 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
28417 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
28418 that the trace run will stop.
28422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
28426 @subheading -trace-stop
28427 @findex -trace-stop
28429 @subsubheading Synopsis
28435 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
28436 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
28437 @samp{running} fields are not output.
28439 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28441 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
28444 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28445 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
28446 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
28450 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
28451 @findex -symbol-info-address
28453 @subsubheading Synopsis
28456 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
28459 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
28461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28463 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
28465 @subsubheading Example
28469 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
28470 @findex -symbol-info-file
28472 @subsubheading Synopsis
28478 Show the file for the symbol.
28480 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28482 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
28483 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
28485 @subsubheading Example
28489 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
28490 @findex -symbol-info-function
28492 @subsubheading Synopsis
28495 -symbol-info-function
28498 Show which function the symbol lives in.
28500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28502 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
28504 @subsubheading Example
28508 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
28509 @findex -symbol-info-line
28511 @subsubheading Synopsis
28517 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
28519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
28522 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
28524 @subsubheading Example
28528 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
28529 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
28531 @subsubheading Synopsis
28534 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
28537 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
28539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28541 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
28543 @subsubheading Example
28547 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
28548 @findex -symbol-list-functions
28550 @subsubheading Synopsis
28553 -symbol-list-functions
28556 List the functions in the executable.
28558 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28560 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
28561 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28563 @subsubheading Example
28568 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
28569 @findex -symbol-list-lines
28571 @subsubheading Synopsis
28574 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
28577 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
28578 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
28579 ascending PC order.
28581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28583 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
28585 @subsubheading Example
28588 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
28589 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
28595 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
28596 @findex -symbol-list-types
28598 @subsubheading Synopsis
28604 List all the type names.
28606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28608 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
28609 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28611 @subsubheading Example
28615 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
28616 @findex -symbol-list-variables
28618 @subsubheading Synopsis
28621 -symbol-list-variables
28624 List all the global and static variable names.
28626 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28628 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28630 @subsubheading Example
28634 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
28635 @findex -symbol-locate
28637 @subsubheading Synopsis
28643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28645 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
28647 @subsubheading Example
28651 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
28652 @findex -symbol-type
28654 @subsubheading Synopsis
28657 -symbol-type @var{variable}
28660 Show type of @var{variable}.
28662 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28664 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
28665 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
28667 @subsubheading Example
28672 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28673 @node GDB/MI File Commands
28674 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
28676 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
28677 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
28679 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
28680 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
28682 @subsubheading Synopsis
28685 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
28688 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
28689 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
28690 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
28691 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
28692 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
28695 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28697 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
28699 @subsubheading Example
28703 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
28709 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
28710 @findex -file-exec-file
28712 @subsubheading Synopsis
28715 -file-exec-file @var{file}
28718 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
28719 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
28720 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
28721 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
28724 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28726 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
28728 @subsubheading Example
28732 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
28739 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
28740 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
28742 @subsubheading Synopsis
28745 -file-list-exec-sections
28748 List the sections of the current executable file.
28750 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28752 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
28753 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
28754 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
28756 @subsubheading Example
28761 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
28762 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
28764 @subsubheading Synopsis
28767 -file-list-exec-source-file
28770 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
28771 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
28772 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
28773 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
28775 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28777 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
28779 @subsubheading Example
28783 123-file-list-exec-source-file
28784 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
28789 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
28790 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
28792 @subsubheading Synopsis
28795 -file-list-exec-source-files
28798 List the source files for the current executable.
28800 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
28801 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
28803 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28805 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
28806 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
28808 @subsubheading Example
28811 -file-list-exec-source-files
28813 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
28814 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
28815 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
28820 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
28821 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
28823 @subsubheading Synopsis
28826 -file-list-shared-libraries
28829 List the shared libraries in the program.
28831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28833 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
28835 @subsubheading Example
28839 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
28840 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
28842 @subsubheading Synopsis
28845 -file-list-symbol-files
28850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28852 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
28854 @subsubheading Example
28859 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
28860 @findex -file-symbol-file
28862 @subsubheading Synopsis
28865 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
28868 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
28869 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
28870 produced, except for a completion notification.
28872 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28874 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
28876 @subsubheading Example
28880 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
28886 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28887 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
28888 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
28890 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
28892 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
28894 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
28896 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
28898 @c @subheading -overlay-map
28900 @c @subheading -overlay-off
28902 @c @subheading -overlay-on
28904 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
28906 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28907 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
28908 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
28910 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
28912 @c @subheading -signal-handle
28914 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
28916 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
28920 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28921 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
28922 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
28925 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
28926 @findex -target-attach
28928 @subsubheading Synopsis
28931 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
28934 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
28935 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
28936 group, the id previously returned by
28937 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
28939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28941 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
28943 @subsubheading Example
28947 =thread-created,id="1"
28948 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
28954 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
28955 @findex -target-compare-sections
28957 @subsubheading Synopsis
28960 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
28963 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
28964 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
28966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28968 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
28970 @subsubheading Example
28975 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
28976 @findex -target-detach
28978 @subsubheading Synopsis
28981 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
28984 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
28985 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
28986 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
28988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28990 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
28992 @subsubheading Example
29002 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
29003 @findex -target-disconnect
29005 @subsubheading Synopsis
29011 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
29012 generally not resumed.
29014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
29018 @subsubheading Example
29028 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
29029 @findex -target-download
29031 @subsubheading Synopsis
29037 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
29038 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
29042 The name of the section.
29044 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
29046 The size of the section.
29048 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
29050 The size of the overall executable to download.
29054 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
29055 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
29057 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
29058 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
29062 The name of the section.
29064 The size of the section.
29066 The size of the overall executable to download.
29070 At the end, a summary is printed.
29072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29074 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
29076 @subsubheading Example
29078 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
29079 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
29084 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
29085 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
29086 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
29087 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
29088 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
29089 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
29090 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
29091 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
29092 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
29093 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
29094 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
29095 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
29096 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
29097 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
29098 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
29099 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
29100 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
29101 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
29102 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
29103 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
29104 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
29105 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
29106 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
29107 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
29108 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
29109 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
29110 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
29111 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
29112 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
29113 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
29114 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
29115 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
29116 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
29117 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
29118 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
29119 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
29120 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
29121 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
29122 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
29123 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
29124 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
29125 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
29126 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
29133 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
29134 @findex -target-exec-status
29136 @subsubheading Synopsis
29139 -target-exec-status
29142 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
29143 not, for instance).
29145 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29147 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29149 @subsubheading Example
29153 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
29154 @findex -target-list-available-targets
29156 @subsubheading Synopsis
29159 -target-list-available-targets
29162 List the possible targets to connect to.
29164 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29166 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
29168 @subsubheading Example
29172 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
29173 @findex -target-list-current-targets
29175 @subsubheading Synopsis
29178 -target-list-current-targets
29181 Describe the current target.
29183 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29185 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
29188 @subsubheading Example
29192 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
29193 @findex -target-list-parameters
29195 @subsubheading Synopsis
29198 -target-list-parameters
29204 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29208 @subsubheading Example
29212 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
29213 @findex -target-select
29215 @subsubheading Synopsis
29218 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
29221 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
29225 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
29226 @item @var{parameters}
29227 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
29228 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
29231 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
29232 which the target program is, in the following form:
29235 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
29236 args=[@var{arg list}]
29239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29241 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
29243 @subsubheading Example
29247 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
29248 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
29252 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29253 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
29254 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
29257 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
29258 @findex -target-file-put
29260 @subsubheading Synopsis
29263 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
29266 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
29267 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
29269 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29271 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
29273 @subsubheading Example
29277 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
29283 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
29284 @findex -target-file-get
29286 @subsubheading Synopsis
29289 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
29292 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
29293 on the host system.
29295 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29297 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
29299 @subsubheading Example
29303 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
29309 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
29310 @findex -target-file-delete
29312 @subsubheading Synopsis
29315 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
29318 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
29320 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29322 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
29324 @subsubheading Example
29328 -target-file-delete remotefile
29334 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29335 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
29336 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
29338 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
29340 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
29343 @subsubheading Synopsis
29349 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
29351 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29353 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
29355 @subsubheading Example
29365 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
29366 @findex -exec-abort
29368 @subsubheading Synopsis
29374 Kill the inferior running program.
29376 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29378 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
29380 @subsubheading Example
29385 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
29388 @subsubheading Synopsis
29394 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
29395 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
29397 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29399 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
29401 @subsubheading Example
29411 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
29414 @subsubheading Synopsis
29420 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
29422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
29426 @subsubheading Example
29435 @c @subheading -gdb-source
29438 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
29439 @findex -gdb-version
29441 @subsubheading Synopsis
29447 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
29449 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29451 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
29452 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
29454 @subsubheading Example
29456 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
29462 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
29463 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
29464 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
29465 ~ certain conditions.
29466 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
29467 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
29469 ~This GDB was configured as
29470 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
29475 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
29476 @findex -list-features
29478 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
29479 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
29480 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
29481 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
29482 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
29485 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
29486 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
29487 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
29493 (gdb) -list-features
29494 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
29497 The current list of features is:
29500 @item frozen-varobjs
29501 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
29502 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
29503 of @code{-varobj-create}.
29504 @item pending-breakpoints
29505 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
29507 Indicates presence of Python scripting support, Python-based
29508 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
29509 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
29511 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
29512 @item data-read-memory-bytes
29513 Indicates presense of the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
29514 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
29518 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
29519 @findex -list-target-features
29521 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
29522 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
29523 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
29524 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
29525 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
29526 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
29527 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
29531 (gdb) -list-features
29532 ^done,result=["async"]
29535 The current list of features is:
29539 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
29540 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
29541 while the target is running.
29544 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
29545 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
29549 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
29550 @findex -list-thread-groups
29552 @subheading Synopsis
29555 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
29558 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
29559 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
29560 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
29561 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
29562 top-level thread groups.
29564 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
29565 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
29566 available on the target.
29568 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
29569 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
29570 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
29571 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
29572 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
29573 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
29574 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
29575 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
29577 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
29578 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
29579 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
29580 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
29581 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
29582 @samp{threads} field.
29584 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
29585 the following caveats:
29589 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
29590 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
29591 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
29594 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
29595 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
29596 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
29597 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
29598 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
29599 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
29603 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
29604 have the following fields:
29608 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
29609 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
29610 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
29613 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
29617 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
29618 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
29621 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
29622 absent for an available thread group.
29625 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
29626 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
29627 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
29630 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
29631 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
29632 such information is not available.
29635 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
29636 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
29637 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
29641 @subheading Example
29645 -list-thread-groups
29646 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
29647 -list-thread-groups 17
29648 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29649 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
29650 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29651 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29652 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
29653 -list-thread-groups --available
29654 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
29655 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
29656 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
29657 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
29658 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
29659 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
29660 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
29661 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
29662 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
29666 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
29667 @findex -add-inferior
29669 @subheading Synopsis
29675 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
29676 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
29677 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
29678 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
29679 field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the
29680 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
29682 @subheading Example
29687 ^done,thread-group="i3"
29690 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
29691 @findex -interpreter-exec
29693 @subheading Synopsis
29696 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
29698 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
29700 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
29702 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29704 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
29706 @subheading Example
29710 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
29711 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
29712 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
29713 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
29718 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
29719 @findex -inferior-tty-set
29721 @subheading Synopsis
29724 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29727 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
29729 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29731 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
29733 @subheading Example
29737 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29742 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
29743 @findex -inferior-tty-show
29745 @subheading Synopsis
29751 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
29753 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29755 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
29757 @subheading Example
29761 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29765 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
29769 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
29770 @findex -enable-timings
29772 @subheading Synopsis
29775 -enable-timings [yes | no]
29778 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
29779 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
29780 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
29781 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
29783 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29787 @subheading Example
29795 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29796 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29797 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
29798 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
29806 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
29807 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
29808 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
29809 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
29814 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
29816 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
29817 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
29818 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
29819 relatively high level.
29821 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
29825 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
29829 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
29830 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
29831 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
29832 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
29833 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
29834 * Annotations for Running::
29835 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
29836 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
29839 @node Annotations Overview
29840 @section What is an Annotation?
29841 @cindex annotations
29843 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
29844 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
29845 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
29846 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
29847 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
29848 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
29849 cannot contain newline characters.
29851 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
29852 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
29853 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
29854 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
29855 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
29856 means those three characters as output.
29858 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
29859 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
29860 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
29861 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
29862 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
29863 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
29864 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
29865 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
29866 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
29869 @kindex set annotate
29870 @item set annotate @var{level}
29871 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
29872 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
29874 @item show annotate
29875 @kindex show annotate
29876 Show the current annotation level.
29879 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
29881 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
29884 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
29886 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
29887 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
29888 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
29889 under certain conditions.
29890 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
29891 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
29893 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
29904 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
29905 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
29906 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
29907 output from @value{GDBN}.
29909 @node Server Prefix
29910 @section The Server Prefix
29911 @cindex server prefix
29913 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
29914 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
29915 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
29916 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
29917 a transparent manner.
29919 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
29920 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
29921 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
29922 @code{print} command.
29924 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
29925 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
29928 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
29930 @cindex annotations for prompts
29931 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
29932 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
29935 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
29936 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
29937 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
29938 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
29939 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
29940 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
29941 features the following annotations:
29949 The input types are
29952 @findex pre-prompt annotation
29953 @findex prompt annotation
29954 @findex post-prompt annotation
29956 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
29958 @findex pre-commands annotation
29959 @findex commands annotation
29960 @findex post-commands annotation
29962 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
29963 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
29965 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
29966 @findex overload-choice annotation
29967 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
29968 @item overload-choice
29969 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
29971 @findex pre-query annotation
29972 @findex query annotation
29973 @findex post-query annotation
29975 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
29977 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
29978 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
29979 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
29980 @item prompt-for-continue
29981 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
29982 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
29983 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
29984 presence of annotations.
29989 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
29991 @findex quit annotation
29996 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
29998 @findex error annotation
30003 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
30005 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
30006 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
30007 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
30008 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
30009 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
30010 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
30013 @findex error-begin annotation
30014 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
30020 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
30023 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
30024 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
30025 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
30028 @section Invalidation Notices
30030 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
30031 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
30035 @findex frames-invalid annotation
30036 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
30038 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
30041 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
30042 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
30044 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
30045 deleted a breakpoint.
30048 @node Annotations for Running
30049 @section Running the Program
30050 @cindex annotations for running programs
30052 @findex starting annotation
30053 @findex stopping annotation
30054 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
30055 @code{step} or @code{continue},
30061 is output. When the program stops,
30067 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
30068 annotations describe how the program stopped.
30071 @findex exited annotation
30072 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
30073 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
30074 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
30076 @findex signalled annotation
30077 @findex signal-name annotation
30078 @findex signal-name-end annotation
30079 @findex signal-string annotation
30080 @findex signal-string-end annotation
30081 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
30082 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
30083 annotation continues:
30089 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
30093 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
30098 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
30099 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
30100 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
30101 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
30102 user's benefit and have no particular format.
30104 @findex signal annotation
30106 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
30107 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
30108 terminated with it.
30110 @findex breakpoint annotation
30111 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
30112 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
30114 @findex watchpoint annotation
30115 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
30116 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
30119 @node Source Annotations
30120 @section Displaying Source
30121 @cindex annotations for source display
30123 @findex source annotation
30124 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
30127 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
30130 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
30131 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
30132 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
30133 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
30134 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
30135 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
30136 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
30137 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
30138 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
30139 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
30140 depend on the language).
30142 @node JIT Interface
30143 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
30144 @cindex just-in-time compilation
30145 @cindex JIT compilation interface
30147 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
30148 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
30149 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
30150 performance while maintaining platform independence.
30152 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
30153 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
30154 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
30155 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
30156 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
30157 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
30159 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
30160 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
30161 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
30162 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
30165 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
30166 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
30167 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
30168 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
30169 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
30170 out about additional code.
30173 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
30174 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
30175 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
30179 @section JIT Declarations
30181 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
30182 implement the interface:
30192 struct jit_code_entry
30194 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
30195 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
30196 const char *symfile_addr;
30197 uint64_t symfile_size;
30200 struct jit_descriptor
30203 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
30204 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
30205 uint32_t action_flag;
30206 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
30207 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
30210 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
30211 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
30213 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
30214 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
30215 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
30218 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
30219 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
30220 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
30222 @node Registering Code
30223 @section Registering Code
30225 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
30229 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
30230 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
30233 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
30237 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
30240 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
30243 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
30244 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
30247 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
30248 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
30249 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
30250 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
30252 @node Unregistering Code
30253 @section Unregistering Code
30255 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
30259 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
30262 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
30265 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
30266 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
30269 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
30270 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
30273 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
30274 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
30275 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
30277 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
30279 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
30280 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
30281 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
30282 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
30284 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
30285 information that enables us to fix the bug.
30288 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
30289 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
30293 @section Have You Found a Bug?
30294 @cindex bug criteria
30296 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
30299 @cindex fatal signal
30300 @cindex debugger crash
30301 @cindex crash of debugger
30303 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
30304 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
30306 @cindex error on valid input
30308 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
30309 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
30310 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
30312 @cindex invalid input
30314 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
30315 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
30316 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
30317 for traditional practice''.
30320 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
30321 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
30324 @node Bug Reporting
30325 @section How to Report Bugs
30326 @cindex bug reports
30327 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
30329 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
30330 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
30331 contact that organization first.
30333 You can find contact information for many support companies and
30334 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
30336 @c should add a web page ref...
30339 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
30340 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
30341 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
30342 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
30343 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
30346 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
30347 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
30348 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
30351 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
30352 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
30353 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
30354 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
30355 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
30356 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
30357 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
30358 bug reports to the mailing list.
30360 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
30361 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
30362 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
30366 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
30367 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
30368 fact or leave it out, state it!
30370 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
30371 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
30372 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
30373 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
30374 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
30375 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
30376 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
30377 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
30378 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
30380 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
30381 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
30382 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
30385 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
30386 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
30387 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
30390 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
30394 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
30395 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
30398 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
30399 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
30402 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
30406 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
30407 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
30410 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
30411 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
30412 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
30413 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
30417 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
30418 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
30419 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
30420 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
30422 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
30423 and then we might not encounter the bug.
30426 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
30430 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
30431 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
30433 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
30434 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
30435 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
30436 a chance to make a mistake.
30438 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
30439 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
30440 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
30441 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
30442 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
30443 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
30444 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
30445 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
30448 @cindex recording a session script
30449 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
30450 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
30451 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
30452 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
30454 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
30455 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
30458 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
30459 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
30460 it by context, not by line number.
30462 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
30463 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
30467 Here are some things that are not necessary:
30471 A description of the envelope of the bug.
30473 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
30474 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
30475 changes will not affect it.
30477 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
30478 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
30479 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
30480 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
30482 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
30483 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
30484 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
30485 less time, and so on.
30487 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
30488 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
30491 A patch for the bug.
30493 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
30494 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
30495 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
30496 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
30498 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
30499 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
30500 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
30501 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
30503 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
30504 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
30505 help us to understand.
30508 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
30510 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
30511 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
30514 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
30515 @c and consists of the two following files:
30517 @c inc-hist.texinfo
30518 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
30519 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
30520 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
30521 @include rluser.texi
30522 @include inc-hist.texinfo
30526 @node Formatting Documentation
30527 @appendix Formatting Documentation
30529 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
30530 @cindex reference card
30531 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
30532 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
30533 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
30534 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
30535 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
30536 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
30538 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
30539 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
30545 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
30546 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
30547 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
30548 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
30549 your @sc{dvi} output program.
30551 @cindex documentation
30553 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
30554 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
30555 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
30556 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
30557 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
30558 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
30560 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
30561 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
30562 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
30563 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
30564 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
30565 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
30566 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
30567 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
30569 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
30570 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
30573 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
30574 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
30575 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
30582 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
30583 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
30584 Texinfo definitions file.
30586 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
30587 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
30588 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
30589 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
30590 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
30591 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
30592 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
30594 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
30595 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
30596 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
30597 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
30598 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
30601 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
30602 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
30603 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
30604 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
30610 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
30612 @node Installing GDB
30613 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
30614 @cindex installation
30617 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
30618 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
30619 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
30620 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
30621 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
30622 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
30626 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
30627 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
30629 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
30630 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
30632 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
30634 @item ISO C90 compiler
30635 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
30636 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
30640 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
30644 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
30645 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
30646 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
30647 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
30648 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
30649 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
30655 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
30657 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
30659 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
30661 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
30665 @cindex compressed debug sections
30666 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
30667 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
30668 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
30669 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
30670 information in such binaries.
30672 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
30673 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
30674 @url{http://zlib.net}.
30677 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
30678 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
30679 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
30680 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
30682 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
30683 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
30684 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
30686 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
30687 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
30688 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
30689 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
30690 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
30691 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
30692 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
30693 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
30696 @node Running Configure
30697 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
30698 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
30699 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
30700 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
30701 build the @code{gdb} program.
30703 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
30704 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
30705 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
30706 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
30709 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
30710 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
30711 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
30713 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
30714 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
30717 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
30718 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
30720 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
30721 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
30723 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
30724 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
30726 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
30727 @sc{gnu} include files
30729 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
30730 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
30732 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
30733 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
30735 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
30736 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
30738 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
30739 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
30741 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
30742 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
30745 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
30746 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
30747 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
30749 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
30750 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
30751 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
30757 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
30758 ./configure @var{host}
30763 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
30764 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
30765 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
30766 correct value by examining your system.)
30768 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
30769 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
30770 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
30771 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
30774 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
30775 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
30776 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
30779 sh configure @var{host}
30782 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
30783 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
30784 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
30786 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
30787 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
30789 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
30790 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
30791 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
30792 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
30793 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
30794 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
30795 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
30796 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
30797 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
30799 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
30800 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
30801 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
30802 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
30803 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
30805 @node Separate Objdir
30806 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
30808 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
30809 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
30810 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
30811 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
30812 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
30813 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
30814 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
30815 program specified there.
30817 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
30818 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
30819 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
30820 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
30821 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
30822 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
30824 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
30825 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
30829 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
30832 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
30837 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
30838 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
30839 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
30840 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
30841 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
30842 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
30844 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
30845 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
30846 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
30847 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
30848 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
30850 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
30851 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
30852 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
30853 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
30854 You specify a cross-debugging target by
30855 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
30857 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
30858 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
30859 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
30861 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
30862 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
30863 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
30864 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
30865 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
30867 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
30868 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
30869 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
30873 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
30875 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
30876 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
30877 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
30878 of information in the following pattern:
30881 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
30884 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
30885 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
30886 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
30888 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
30889 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
30890 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
30891 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
30892 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
30893 abbreviations---for example:
30896 % sh config.sub i386-linux
30898 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
30899 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
30900 % sh config.sub hp9k700
30902 % sh config.sub sun4
30903 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
30904 % sh config.sub sun3
30905 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
30906 % sh config.sub i986v
30907 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
30911 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
30912 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
30914 @node Configure Options
30915 @section @file{configure} Options
30917 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
30918 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
30919 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
30920 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
30923 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
30924 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
30925 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
30926 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
30927 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
30928 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
30933 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
30934 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
30939 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
30941 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
30942 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
30945 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
30946 Configure the source to install programs under directory
30949 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
30951 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
30952 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
30953 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
30954 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
30955 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
30956 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
30957 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
30958 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
30959 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
30960 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
30963 @item --norecursion
30964 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
30965 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
30967 @item --target=@var{target}
30968 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
30969 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
30970 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
30972 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
30974 @item @var{host} @dots{}
30975 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
30977 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
30980 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
30981 needed for special purposes only.
30983 @node System-wide configuration
30984 @section System-wide configuration and settings
30985 @cindex system-wide init file
30987 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
30988 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
30989 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
30991 Here is the corresponding configure option:
30994 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
30995 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
30999 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
31000 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
31004 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
31005 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
31006 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
31007 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
31008 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
31009 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
31012 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
31013 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
31014 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
31015 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
31016 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
31019 @node Maintenance Commands
31020 @appendix Maintenance Commands
31021 @cindex maintenance commands
31022 @cindex internal commands
31024 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
31025 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
31026 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
31027 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
31028 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
31031 @kindex maint agent
31032 @kindex maint agent-eval
31033 @item maint agent @var{expression}
31034 @itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
31035 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
31036 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
31037 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
31038 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
31039 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
31040 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
31041 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
31042 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
31043 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
31044 addition and return the sum.
31046 @kindex maint info breakpoints
31047 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
31048 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
31049 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
31050 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
31051 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
31056 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
31059 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
31062 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
31063 @code{longjmp} calls.
31065 @item longjmp resume
31066 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
31069 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
31072 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
31075 Shared library events.
31079 @kindex set displaced-stepping
31080 @kindex show displaced-stepping
31081 @cindex displaced stepping support
31082 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
31083 @item set displaced-stepping
31084 @itemx show displaced-stepping
31085 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
31086 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
31087 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
31088 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
31089 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
31092 @item set displaced-stepping on
31093 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
31094 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
31096 @item set displaced-stepping off
31097 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
31098 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
31100 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
31101 @item set displaced-stepping auto
31102 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
31103 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
31104 architecture supports displaced stepping.
31107 @kindex maint check-symtabs
31108 @item maint check-symtabs
31109 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
31111 @kindex maint cplus first_component
31112 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
31113 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
31115 @kindex maint cplus namespace
31116 @item maint cplus namespace
31117 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
31119 @kindex maint demangle
31120 @item maint demangle @var{name}
31121 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
31123 @kindex maint deprecate
31124 @kindex maint undeprecate
31125 @cindex deprecated commands
31126 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
31127 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
31128 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
31129 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
31130 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
31131 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
31132 the replacement as part of the warning.
31134 @kindex maint dump-me
31135 @item maint dump-me
31136 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
31137 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
31138 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
31139 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
31141 @kindex maint internal-error
31142 @kindex maint internal-warning
31143 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
31144 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
31145 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
31146 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
31147 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
31148 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
31149 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
31150 @value{GDBN} session.
31152 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
31153 used as the text of the error or warning message.
31155 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
31158 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
31159 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
31160 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
31161 debugging may prove unreliable.
31162 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
31163 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
31167 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
31168 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
31170 @kindex maint set internal-error
31171 @kindex maint show internal-error
31172 @kindex maint set internal-warning
31173 @kindex maint show internal-warning
31174 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
31175 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
31176 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
31177 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
31178 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
31179 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
31180 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
31181 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
31182 described in the table below.
31186 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
31187 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
31190 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
31191 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
31194 @kindex maint packet
31195 @item maint packet @var{text}
31196 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
31197 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
31198 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
31199 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
31202 @kindex maint print architecture
31203 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31204 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
31205 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
31207 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
31208 @item maint print c-tdesc
31209 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
31210 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
31211 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
31213 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
31214 @item maint print dummy-frames
31215 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
31218 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
31220 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
31221 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
31223 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
31225 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
31226 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
31227 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
31228 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
31232 Takes an optional file parameter.
31234 @kindex maint print registers
31235 @kindex maint print raw-registers
31236 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
31237 @kindex maint print register-groups
31238 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31239 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31240 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31241 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31242 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
31244 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
31245 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
31246 includes the (cooked) value of all registers, including registers which
31247 aren't available on the target nor visible to user; and the
31248 command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
31249 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
31250 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
31252 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
31253 write the information.
31255 @kindex maint print reggroups
31256 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31257 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
31258 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
31261 The register groups info looks like this:
31264 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
31277 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
31279 @kindex maint print objfiles
31280 @cindex info for known object files
31281 @item maint print objfiles
31282 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
31283 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
31286 @kindex maint print section-scripts
31287 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
31288 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
31289 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
31290 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
31291 matching @var{regexp}.
31292 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
31293 and the full path if known.
31294 @xref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}.
31296 @kindex maint print statistics
31297 @cindex bcache statistics
31298 @item maint print statistics
31299 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
31300 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
31301 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
31302 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
31303 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
31304 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
31305 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
31306 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
31307 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
31308 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
31311 @kindex maint print target-stack
31312 @cindex target stack description
31313 @item maint print target-stack
31314 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
31315 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
31316 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
31317 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
31318 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
31321 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
31322 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
31324 @kindex maint print type
31325 @cindex type chain of a data type
31326 @item maint print type @var{expr}
31327 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
31328 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
31329 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
31330 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
31331 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
31333 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
31334 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
31335 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
31336 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
31337 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
31340 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
31341 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
31342 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
31343 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
31344 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
31345 always see the disassembly form.
31347 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
31350 (gdb) info addr argc
31351 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
31355 For more information on these expressions, see
31356 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
31358 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
31359 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
31360 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
31361 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
31362 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
31364 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
31365 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
31366 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
31367 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
31368 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
31369 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
31370 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
31371 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
31372 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
31374 @kindex maint set profile
31375 @kindex maint show profile
31376 @cindex profiling GDB
31377 @item maint set profile
31378 @itemx maint show profile
31379 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
31381 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
31382 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
31383 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
31384 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
31385 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
31386 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
31387 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
31389 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
31390 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
31392 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
31393 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
31394 @cindex hardware debug registers
31395 @item maint set show-debug-regs
31396 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
31397 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
31398 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
31399 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
31400 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
31401 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
31403 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
31404 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
31405 @item maint set show-all-tib
31406 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
31407 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
31408 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
31411 @kindex maint space
31412 @cindex memory used by commands
31414 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
31415 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
31416 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
31417 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
31418 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
31421 @cindex time of command execution
31423 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
31424 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
31425 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
31426 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
31427 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
31428 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
31429 it's not possibly currently
31430 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
31431 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
31433 @kindex maint translate-address
31434 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
31435 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
31436 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
31437 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
31438 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
31439 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
31440 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
31442 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
31443 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
31444 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
31448 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
31449 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
31452 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
31453 @kindex set watchdog
31454 @cindex watchdog timer
31455 @cindex timeout for commands
31456 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
31457 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
31458 reports and error and the command is aborted.
31460 @item show watchdog
31461 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
31464 @node Remote Protocol
31465 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
31470 * Stop Reply Packets::
31471 * General Query Packets::
31472 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
31473 * Tracepoint Packets::
31474 * Host I/O Packets::
31476 * Notification Packets::
31477 * Remote Non-Stop::
31478 * Packet Acknowledgment::
31480 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
31481 * Library List Format::
31482 * Memory Map Format::
31483 * Thread List Format::
31489 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
31490 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
31491 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
31492 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
31494 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
31495 transmitted and received data, respectively.
31497 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
31498 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
31499 @cindex remote serial protocol
31500 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
31501 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
31502 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
31503 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
31504 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
31507 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31511 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
31513 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
31514 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
31515 eight bit unsigned checksum).
31517 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
31518 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
31521 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31524 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
31526 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
31527 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
31528 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
31530 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
31531 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
31532 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
31536 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31541 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
31542 once a connection is established.
31543 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
31545 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
31546 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
31547 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
31548 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
31549 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
31550 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
31551 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
31553 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
31554 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
31557 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
31558 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
31559 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
31560 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
31562 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
31563 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
31564 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
31566 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
31567 @anchor{Binary Data}
31568 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
31569 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
31570 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
31571 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
31572 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
31575 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
31576 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
31577 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
31578 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
31579 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
31580 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
31581 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
31582 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
31583 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
31586 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
31587 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
31588 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
31589 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
31590 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
31591 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
31592 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
31593 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
31594 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
31595 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
31596 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
31599 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
31600 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
31601 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
31602 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
31605 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
31606 error number. That number is not well defined.
31608 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
31609 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
31610 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
31611 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
31614 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
31615 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
31621 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
31622 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
31623 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
31624 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
31626 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
31627 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
31628 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
31629 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
31630 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
31631 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
31632 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
31633 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
31634 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
31637 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
31638 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
31639 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
31640 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
31641 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
31642 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
31645 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
31646 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
31647 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
31648 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
31649 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
31650 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
31651 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
31652 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
31653 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
31654 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
31655 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
31656 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
31657 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
31659 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
31660 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
31661 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
31664 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
31665 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
31667 Here are the packet descriptions.
31672 @cindex @samp{!} packet
31673 @anchor{extended mode}
31674 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
31675 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
31681 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
31685 @cindex @samp{?} packet
31686 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
31687 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
31688 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
31691 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31693 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
31694 @cindex @samp{A} packet
31695 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
31696 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
31697 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
31702 The arguments were set.
31708 @cindex @samp{b} packet
31709 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
31710 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
31712 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
31713 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
31714 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
31716 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
31717 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
31718 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
31719 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
31720 of view, nothing actually happened.}
31722 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
31723 @cindex @samp{B} packet
31724 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
31725 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
31727 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
31728 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
31730 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
31733 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
31734 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31737 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31739 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
31742 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
31743 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31746 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31748 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
31749 @cindex @samp{c} packet
31750 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
31751 resume at current address.
31754 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31756 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
31757 @cindex @samp{C} packet
31758 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
31759 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
31762 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31765 @cindex @samp{d} packet
31768 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
31769 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
31773 @cindex @samp{D} packet
31774 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
31775 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
31776 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
31778 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
31779 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
31780 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
31781 big-endian hex string.
31791 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
31792 @cindex @samp{F} packet
31793 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
31794 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
31795 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
31798 @anchor{read registers packet}
31799 @cindex @samp{g} packet
31800 Read general registers.
31804 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
31805 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
31806 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
31807 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
31808 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
31809 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
31810 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
31812 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
31813 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
31814 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
31815 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
31816 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
31817 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
31818 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
31819 have been collected, and both have zero value:
31823 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
31830 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
31831 @cindex @samp{G} packet
31832 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
31833 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
31843 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
31844 @cindex @samp{H} packet
31845 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
31846 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
31847 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
31848 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
31849 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
31860 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
31861 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
31862 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
31863 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
31864 @c described. For example:
31866 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
31867 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
31868 @c otherwise returns current registers.
31870 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
31871 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
31872 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
31874 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
31875 @anchor{cycle step packet}
31876 @cindex @samp{i} packet
31877 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
31878 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
31879 step starting at that address.
31882 @cindex @samp{I} packet
31883 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
31887 @cindex @samp{k} packet
31890 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
31891 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
31894 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
31895 @cindex @samp{m} packet
31896 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
31897 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
31899 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
31900 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
31901 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
31902 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
31903 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
31904 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
31905 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
31906 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
31910 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
31911 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
31912 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
31913 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
31918 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
31919 @cindex @samp{M} packet
31920 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
31921 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
31922 hexadecimal number.
31929 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
31934 @cindex @samp{p} packet
31935 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
31936 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
31937 register value is encoded.
31941 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
31942 the register's value
31946 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
31949 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
31950 @anchor{write register packet}
31951 @cindex @samp{P} packet
31952 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
31953 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
31954 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
31964 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
31965 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
31966 @cindex @samp{q} packet
31967 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
31968 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
31969 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
31972 @cindex @samp{r} packet
31973 Reset the entire system.
31975 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
31978 @cindex @samp{R} packet
31979 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
31980 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
31982 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
31984 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
31985 @cindex @samp{s} packet
31986 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
31987 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
31990 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31992 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
31993 @anchor{step with signal packet}
31994 @cindex @samp{S} packet
31995 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
31996 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
31999 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32001 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
32002 @cindex @samp{t} packet
32003 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
32004 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
32005 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
32007 @item T @var{thread-id}
32008 @cindex @samp{T} packet
32009 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
32014 thread is still alive
32020 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
32021 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
32023 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
32024 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
32025 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
32026 The process ID is a
32027 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
32028 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
32029 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
32031 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
32032 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
32033 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
32034 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
32035 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
32036 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
32037 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
32038 @c stopping or restarting threads.
32040 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
32046 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32047 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32049 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
32052 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
32053 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
32054 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
32055 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
32056 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
32057 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
32058 in their current state in non-stop mode.
32059 Specifying multiple
32060 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
32061 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32063 Currently supported actions are:
32069 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
32073 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
32078 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
32079 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
32080 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
32082 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
32083 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
32084 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
32085 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
32086 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
32087 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
32088 as an implementation detail.
32091 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32094 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
32095 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
32099 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
32100 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
32101 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
32103 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
32106 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
32107 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
32108 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
32109 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
32111 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
32112 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
32113 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
32114 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
32115 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
32116 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
32117 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
32118 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
32119 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
32120 packet is received.
32122 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
32123 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
32124 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
32125 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
32136 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32137 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
32138 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
32139 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
32140 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
32141 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
32142 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
32143 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
32144 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
32145 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
32146 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
32147 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
32155 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
32161 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
32162 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
32163 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
32164 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
32165 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
32166 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
32167 request is completed.
32169 @item vKill;@var{pid}
32170 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
32171 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
32172 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
32173 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
32174 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
32184 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
32185 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
32186 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
32187 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
32188 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
32189 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
32192 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
32194 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
32200 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32201 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32205 @anchor{vStopped packet}
32206 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
32208 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
32209 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
32213 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32214 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32216 if there are no unreported stop events
32219 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32221 @cindex @samp{X} packet
32222 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
32223 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
32224 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
32234 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
32235 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
32236 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
32237 @cindex @samp{z} packet
32238 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
32239 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
32240 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
32242 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
32245 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
32246 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
32247 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
32248 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
32249 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
32250 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
32252 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32253 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32254 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
32255 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
32256 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
32257 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
32259 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
32260 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
32261 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
32262 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
32263 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
32264 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
32265 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
32267 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
32268 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
32269 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
32270 target, is not defined.}
32282 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32283 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32284 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
32285 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
32286 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
32287 address @var{addr}.
32289 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
32290 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
32291 has the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
32293 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
32306 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32307 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32308 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
32309 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
32310 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32311 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32323 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32324 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32325 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
32326 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
32327 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32328 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32340 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32341 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32342 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
32343 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
32344 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32345 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32359 @node Stop Reply Packets
32360 @section Stop Reply Packets
32361 @cindex stop reply packets
32363 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
32364 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
32365 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
32366 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
32367 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
32368 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
32369 @value{GDBN} source code.
32371 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
32372 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
32373 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
32379 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
32380 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
32381 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
32383 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
32384 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
32385 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
32386 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
32387 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
32388 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
32389 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
32390 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
32394 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
32395 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
32396 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
32397 two-digit hex number.
32400 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
32401 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32404 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
32405 the core on which the stop event was detected.
32408 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
32409 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
32410 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
32411 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
32414 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
32415 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
32419 The currently defined stop reasons are:
32425 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
32428 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
32430 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
32431 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
32432 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
32434 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
32436 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
32437 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
32438 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
32439 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
32440 for more information.
32444 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
32445 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
32446 applicable to certain targets.
32448 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
32449 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
32450 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
32451 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
32454 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
32455 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
32457 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
32458 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
32459 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
32460 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
32462 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
32463 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
32464 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
32465 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
32466 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
32468 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
32469 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
32470 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
32471 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
32472 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
32475 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
32476 this very system call.
32478 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
32479 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
32480 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
32481 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
32482 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
32483 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
32487 @node General Query Packets
32488 @section General Query Packets
32489 @cindex remote query requests
32491 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
32492 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
32493 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
32494 sending information to and from the stub.
32496 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
32497 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
32498 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
32499 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
32504 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
32506 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
32509 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
32510 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
32511 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
32512 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
32515 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
32516 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
32517 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
32518 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
32519 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
32520 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
32521 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
32522 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
32523 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
32524 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
32527 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
32528 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
32529 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
32530 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
32531 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
32533 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
32537 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
32538 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
32539 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
32540 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
32541 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
32542 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
32543 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
32544 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
32545 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
32546 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
32547 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
32550 @cindex current thread, remote request
32551 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
32552 Return the current thread ID.
32556 @item QC @var{thread-id}
32557 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
32558 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32559 @item @r{(anything else)}
32560 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
32563 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
32564 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
32565 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
32566 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
32567 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
32568 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
32569 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
32571 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
32572 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
32573 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
32574 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
32575 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
32576 detect trailing zeros.
32581 An error (such as memory fault)
32582 @item C @var{crc32}
32583 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
32587 @itemx qsThreadInfo
32588 @cindex list active threads, remote request
32589 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
32590 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
32591 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
32592 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
32593 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
32594 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
32595 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
32596 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
32598 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
32602 @item m @var{thread-id}
32604 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
32605 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
32607 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
32610 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
32611 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
32612 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
32613 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
32614 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
32615 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
32618 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
32619 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
32620 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
32621 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
32622 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
32624 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
32625 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
32627 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
32628 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
32629 information associated with the variable.)
32631 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
32632 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
32633 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
32634 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
32635 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
32636 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
32640 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
32641 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
32642 local storage requested.
32645 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32648 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
32651 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
32652 @cindex get thread information block address
32653 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
32654 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
32656 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
32660 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
32661 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
32662 thread information block.
32665 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
32666 address could not be retrieved.
32669 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
32672 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
32673 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
32674 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
32675 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
32676 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
32677 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
32678 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
32680 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
32684 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
32685 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
32686 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
32687 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
32688 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
32689 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
32690 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
32694 @cindex section offsets, remote request
32695 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
32696 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
32701 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
32702 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
32703 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
32704 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
32705 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
32706 segments by the supplied offsets.
32708 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
32709 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
32710 to the @code{Bss} section.}
32712 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
32713 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
32714 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
32715 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
32716 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
32717 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
32718 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
32719 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
32720 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
32723 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
32724 @cindex thread information, remote request
32725 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
32726 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
32727 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
32728 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
32730 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
32733 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
32737 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
32738 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
32740 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
32741 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
32746 The request succeeded.
32749 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32752 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
32756 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
32757 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
32758 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
32759 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
32761 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
32762 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
32763 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
32764 @anchor{QPassSignals}
32765 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
32766 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
32767 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
32768 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
32769 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
32770 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
32771 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
32772 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
32773 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
32778 The request succeeded.
32781 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32784 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
32788 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
32789 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
32790 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
32791 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
32793 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
32794 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
32795 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
32796 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
32797 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
32798 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
32799 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
32800 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
32801 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
32806 A command response with no output.
32808 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
32810 Indicate a badly formed request.
32812 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
32815 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
32816 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
32817 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
32820 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
32821 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
32822 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
32823 @anchor{qSearch memory}
32824 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
32825 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
32826 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
32831 The pattern was not found.
32833 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
32835 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
32837 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
32840 @item QStartNoAckMode
32841 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
32842 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
32843 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
32844 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
32849 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
32850 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
32851 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
32852 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
32854 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
32857 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
32858 @cindex supported packets, remote query
32859 @cindex features of the remote protocol
32860 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
32861 @anchor{qSupported}
32862 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
32863 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
32864 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
32865 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
32866 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
32867 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
32868 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
32869 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
32870 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
32871 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
32872 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
32873 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
32874 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
32875 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
32879 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
32880 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
32881 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
32884 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
32885 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
32888 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
32889 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
32893 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
32894 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
32895 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
32896 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
32898 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
32899 need an associated value.
32901 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
32903 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
32904 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
32905 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
32906 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
32909 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
32910 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
32911 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
32912 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
32913 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
32915 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
32920 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
32921 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
32922 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
32923 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
32924 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
32927 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
32928 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
32929 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
32933 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
32934 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
32935 instruction reply packet}).
32938 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
32939 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
32940 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
32941 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
32942 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
32943 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
32944 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
32945 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
32946 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
32947 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
32948 all the features it supports.
32950 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
32951 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
32953 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
32954 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
32955 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
32958 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
32959 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
32960 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
32961 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
32963 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
32964 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
32965 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
32966 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
32967 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
32969 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
32971 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
32972 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
32973 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
32975 @tab Value Required
32979 @item @samp{PacketSize}
32984 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
32989 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
32994 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
32999 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
33004 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
33009 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
33014 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
33019 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
33024 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
33029 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
33035 @item @samp{QNonStop}
33040 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
33045 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
33050 @item @samp{multiprocess}
33055 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
33060 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
33065 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
33070 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
33075 @item @samp{QAllow}
33082 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
33085 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
33086 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
33087 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
33088 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
33089 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
33090 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
33091 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
33092 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
33093 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
33094 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
33096 @item qXfer:auxv:read
33097 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
33098 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
33100 @item qXfer:features:read
33101 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
33102 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
33104 @item qXfer:libraries:read
33105 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
33106 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
33108 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
33109 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
33110 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
33112 @item qXfer:sdata:read
33113 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
33114 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
33116 @item qXfer:spu:read
33117 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
33118 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
33120 @item qXfer:spu:write
33121 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
33122 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
33124 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
33125 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
33126 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
33128 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
33129 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
33130 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
33132 @item qXfer:threads:read
33133 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
33134 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
33137 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
33138 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
33141 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
33142 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
33144 @item QStartNoAckMode
33145 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
33146 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
33149 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
33150 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
33151 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
33152 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
33153 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
33154 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
33155 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
33156 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
33157 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
33158 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
33159 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
33161 @item qXfer:osdata:read
33162 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
33163 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
33165 @item ConditionalTracepoints
33166 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
33167 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
33169 @item ReverseContinue
33170 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
33174 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
33177 @item TracepointSource
33178 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
33179 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
33182 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
33184 @item StaticTracepoint
33185 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
33186 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
33191 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
33192 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
33193 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
33194 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
33199 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
33200 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
33201 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
33202 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
33203 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
33207 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
33208 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
33210 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
33211 target has previously requested.
33213 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
33214 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
33220 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
33221 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
33222 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
33223 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
33224 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
33229 @item QTDisconnected
33236 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
33238 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
33239 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
33240 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
33241 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
33242 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
33243 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
33244 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
33245 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
33246 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
33247 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
33248 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
33252 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
33253 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
33254 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
33255 the thread's attributes.
33258 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
33259 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
33260 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
33275 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
33277 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33278 @cindex read special object, remote request
33279 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
33280 @anchor{qXfer read}
33281 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
33282 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
33283 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
33284 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
33285 additional details about what data to access.
33287 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
33288 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
33289 formats, listed below.
33292 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33293 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
33294 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
33295 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
33297 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33298 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33300 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33301 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
33302 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
33303 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
33304 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
33306 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33307 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33309 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33310 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
33311 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
33312 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33313 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33315 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
33316 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
33317 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
33319 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33320 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33322 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33323 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
33324 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
33325 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33326 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33328 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33329 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33331 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33332 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
33334 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
33335 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
33336 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
33339 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33340 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33341 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33343 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33344 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
33345 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
33346 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
33347 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33349 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33350 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33351 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33353 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33354 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
33355 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
33356 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
33357 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
33358 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
33359 in that context to be accessed.
33361 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33362 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33363 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33365 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33366 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
33367 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
33368 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33369 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33371 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33372 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33374 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33375 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
33376 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
33377 @xref{Operating System Information}.
33384 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
33385 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
33386 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
33387 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
33388 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
33392 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
33393 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
33394 than the @var{length} in the request.
33397 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
33398 There is no more data to be read.
33401 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
33404 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
33405 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
33408 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
33409 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
33412 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33413 @cindex write data into object, remote request
33414 @anchor{qXfer write}
33415 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
33416 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
33417 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
33418 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
33419 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
33422 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
33423 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
33424 formats, listed below.
33427 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33428 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
33429 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
33430 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
33431 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
33433 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33434 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33435 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33437 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33438 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
33439 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
33440 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
33441 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
33442 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
33443 in that context to be accessed.
33445 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33446 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33452 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
33453 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
33456 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
33459 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
33460 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
33463 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
33464 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
33467 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
33468 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
33469 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
33470 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
33471 must respond with an empty packet.
33473 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
33474 @cindex query attached, remote request
33475 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
33476 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
33477 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
33478 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
33479 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
33480 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
33481 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
33483 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
33484 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
33485 the @code{quit} command.
33490 The remote server attached to an existing process.
33492 The remote server created a new process.
33494 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
33499 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
33500 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
33502 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
33503 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
33504 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
33508 @subsubsection Breakpoint Kinds
33510 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
33515 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
33518 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
33521 32-bit ARM mode breakpoint.
33527 @subsubsection Register Packet Format
33529 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
33530 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
33531 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
33532 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
33533 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
33534 most-significant - least-significant.
33540 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
33541 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
33542 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
33546 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
33547 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
33552 @node Tracepoint Packets
33553 @section Tracepoint Packets
33554 @cindex tracepoint packets
33555 @cindex packets, tracepoint
33557 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
33558 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33562 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
33563 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
33564 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
33565 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
33566 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
33567 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
33568 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
33569 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
33570 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
33571 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
33572 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
33573 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
33579 The packet was understood and carried out.
33581 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
33583 The packet was not recognized.
33586 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
33587 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
33588 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
33589 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
33590 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
33591 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
33592 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
33594 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
33595 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
33596 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
33597 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
33598 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
33599 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
33600 tracepoint actions.
33602 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
33603 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
33609 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
33610 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
33611 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
33612 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
33613 not fit in a 32-bit word.
33615 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
33616 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
33617 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
33618 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
33619 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
33620 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
33621 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
33623 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
33624 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
33625 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
33626 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
33627 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
33628 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
33633 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
33634 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
33635 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
33636 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
33637 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
33638 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
33639 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
33640 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
33645 The packet was understood and carried out.
33647 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
33649 The packet was not recognized.
33652 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
33653 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
33654 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
33655 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
33656 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
33657 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
33658 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
33659 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
33661 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
33662 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
33663 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
33664 fit in a single packet.
33665 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
33666 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
33668 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
33669 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
33670 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
33671 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
33673 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
33674 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
33677 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
33678 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
33679 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
33680 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
33681 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
33682 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
33683 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
33686 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
33687 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
33688 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
33689 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
33690 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
33691 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
33692 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
33693 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
33694 mentioned in expressions.
33696 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
33697 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
33698 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
33699 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
33701 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
33702 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
33703 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
33704 one of the following forms:
33708 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
33709 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
33710 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
33713 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
33714 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
33718 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
33719 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33720 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
33721 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
33723 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
33724 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33725 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
33726 is a hexadecimal number.
33728 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
33729 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33730 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
33731 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
33734 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
33735 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
33736 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
33739 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
33740 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
33741 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
33742 instruction reply packet}).
33745 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
33748 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
33750 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
33751 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
33752 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
33753 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
33755 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
33756 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
33757 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
33758 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
33760 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
33761 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
33762 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
33763 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
33764 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
33767 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
33769 The reply has the form:
33773 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
33774 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
33775 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
33776 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
33780 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
33781 explanations as one of the optional fields:
33786 No trace has been run yet.
33789 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command.
33792 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
33794 @item tdisconnected:0
33795 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
33797 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
33798 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
33800 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
33801 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
33802 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
33803 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
33804 @var{text} is hex encoded.
33807 The trace stopped for some other reason.
33811 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
33812 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
33813 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
33814 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
33819 @item tframes:@var{n}
33820 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
33822 @item tcreated:@var{n}
33823 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
33824 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
33826 @item tsize:@var{n}
33827 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
33829 @item tfree:@var{n}
33830 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
33832 @item circular:@var{n}
33833 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
33834 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
33835 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
33838 @item disconn:@var{n}
33839 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
33840 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
33841 that the trace run will stop.
33845 @item qTV:@var{var}
33846 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
33847 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
33848 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
33853 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
33854 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
33855 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
33856 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
33857 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
33858 program is running.
33861 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
33862 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
33868 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
33869 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
33870 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
33871 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
33872 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
33876 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
33877 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
33878 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
33879 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
33880 trace state variables.
33884 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
33885 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
33886 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
33887 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
33891 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
33893 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
33894 a comma-separated list of markers
33896 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
33898 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
33900 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
33904 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
33905 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
33907 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
33908 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
33909 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
33910 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
33913 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
33914 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
33915 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
33916 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
33917 tracepoint markers.
33919 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
33920 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
33921 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
33922 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
33923 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
33925 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
33926 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
33927 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
33928 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
33929 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
33930 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
33931 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
33934 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
33935 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
33936 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
33940 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
33941 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
33942 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
33943 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
33944 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
33945 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
33946 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
33947 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
33948 it had executed in the original location.
33950 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
33951 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
33952 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
33953 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
33954 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
33955 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
33956 format of the request is:
33959 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
33961 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
33962 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
33963 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
33964 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
33965 memory starting at @var{to}.
33970 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
33971 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
33972 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
33974 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
33975 relocating the instruction.
33978 @node Host I/O Packets
33979 @section Host I/O Packets
33980 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
33981 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
33983 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
33984 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
33985 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
33986 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
33987 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
33988 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
33989 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
33990 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
33991 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
33992 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
33994 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
33995 its arguments. They have this format:
33999 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
34000 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
34001 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
34002 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
34003 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
34004 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
34005 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
34006 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
34007 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34011 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
34015 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
34016 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
34017 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
34018 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
34019 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
34020 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
34021 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
34022 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
34023 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
34027 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
34031 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
34034 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
34035 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
34036 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
34037 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
34038 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
34039 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
34040 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
34042 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
34043 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
34044 -1 if an error occurs.
34046 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
34047 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
34048 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
34049 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
34050 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
34051 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
34052 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
34053 @var{count} was zero.
34055 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
34056 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
34057 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
34058 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
34059 some characters were escaped.
34061 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
34062 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
34063 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
34064 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
34065 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
34066 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
34067 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
34070 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
34071 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
34072 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
34077 @section Interrupts
34078 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
34080 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
34081 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
34082 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
34083 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
34085 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
34086 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
34087 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
34088 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
34089 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
34091 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
34092 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
34093 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
34094 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
34095 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
34096 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
34097 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
34098 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
34100 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
34101 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
34102 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
34104 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
34105 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
34106 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
34107 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
34108 currently-executing threads and processes.
34109 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
34110 running program, it should send one of the stop
34111 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
34112 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
34113 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
34114 Interrupts received while the
34115 program is stopped are discarded.
34117 @node Notification Packets
34118 @section Notification Packets
34119 @cindex notification packets
34120 @cindex packets, notification
34122 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
34123 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
34124 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
34125 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
34126 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
34127 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
34130 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
34131 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
34132 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
34133 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
34134 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
34135 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
34136 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
34138 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
34139 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
34141 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
34142 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
34143 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
34144 not they understand it.
34146 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
34147 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
34148 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
34149 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
34152 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
34153 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
34154 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
34155 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
34156 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
34158 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
34162 @item Stop: @var{reply}
34163 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
34164 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
34165 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
34166 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
34170 @node Remote Non-Stop
34171 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
34173 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
34174 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
34175 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
34176 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34178 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
34179 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
34180 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
34181 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
34182 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
34183 probe the target state after a mode change.
34185 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
34186 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
34187 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
34188 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
34189 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
34190 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
34191 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
34192 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
34193 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
34194 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
34195 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
34197 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
34198 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
34199 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
34200 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
34201 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
34202 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
34203 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
34204 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
34205 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
34206 sending any queued stop events.
34208 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
34209 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
34210 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
34211 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
34212 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
34213 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
34214 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
34216 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
34217 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
34218 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
34219 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
34220 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
34223 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
34224 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
34225 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
34226 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
34227 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
34228 should process normally.
34230 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
34231 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
34232 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
34233 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
34234 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
34236 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
34237 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
34238 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
34239 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
34240 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
34241 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
34242 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
34243 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
34244 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
34245 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
34246 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
34249 @node Packet Acknowledgment
34250 @section Packet Acknowledgment
34252 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
34253 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
34254 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
34255 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34256 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
34257 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
34258 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
34260 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
34261 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
34262 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
34263 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
34264 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
34266 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
34267 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
34268 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
34269 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
34271 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
34272 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
34273 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
34274 @pxref{qSupported}.
34275 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
34276 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
34277 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
34278 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
34279 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
34280 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
34281 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
34283 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
34284 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
34285 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
34287 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
34288 new connection is established,
34289 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
34290 for the current connection, once disabled.
34295 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
34296 does not get any direct output:
34301 @emph{target restarts}
34304 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
34308 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
34311 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
34316 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
34320 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
34324 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
34325 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
34326 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
34329 * File-I/O Overview::
34330 * Protocol Basics::
34331 * The F Request Packet::
34332 * The F Reply Packet::
34333 * The Ctrl-C Message::
34335 * List of Supported Calls::
34336 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
34338 * File-I/O Examples::
34341 @node File-I/O Overview
34342 @subsection File-I/O Overview
34343 @cindex file-i/o overview
34345 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
34346 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
34347 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
34348 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
34349 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
34350 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
34352 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
34353 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
34354 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
34355 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
34356 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
34358 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
34359 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34360 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
34361 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
34362 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
34363 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
34364 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
34366 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
34367 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
34368 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
34369 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
34370 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
34373 (@value{GDBP}) continue
34374 <- target requests 'system call X'
34375 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
34376 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
34377 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
34378 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
34381 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
34382 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
34383 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
34384 system are not supported by this protocol.
34386 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
34388 @node Protocol Basics
34389 @subsection Protocol Basics
34390 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
34392 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
34393 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
34394 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
34395 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
34396 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
34397 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
34398 to call the appropriate host system call:
34402 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
34405 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
34406 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
34407 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
34408 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
34412 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
34416 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
34417 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
34418 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
34419 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
34423 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
34424 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
34427 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
34430 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
34433 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
34434 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
34435 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
34436 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
34441 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
34442 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
34449 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
34456 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
34457 the latest continue or step action.
34459 @node The F Request Packet
34460 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
34461 @cindex file-i/o request packet
34462 @cindex @code{F} request packet
34464 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
34467 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
34469 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
34470 This is just the name of the function.
34472 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
34473 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
34474 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
34475 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
34476 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
34477 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
34478 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
34484 @node The F Reply Packet
34485 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
34486 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
34487 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
34489 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
34493 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
34495 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
34497 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
34499 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
34501 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
34502 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
34503 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
34510 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
34517 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
34522 @node The Ctrl-C Message
34523 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
34524 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
34526 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
34527 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
34528 the target should behave as if it had
34529 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
34530 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
34531 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
34534 It's important for the target to know in which
34535 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
34539 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
34542 The system call on the host has been finished.
34546 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
34547 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
34548 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
34549 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
34550 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
34551 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
34553 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
34554 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
34555 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
34556 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
34557 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
34558 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
34559 or the full action has been completed.
34562 @subsection Console I/O
34563 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
34565 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
34566 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
34567 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
34568 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
34569 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
34570 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
34575 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
34577 system call is treated as finished.
34580 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
34584 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
34585 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
34589 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
34590 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
34591 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
34592 is stopped at the user's request.
34595 @node List of Supported Calls
34596 @subsection List of Supported Calls
34597 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
34614 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
34615 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
34620 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
34621 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
34625 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
34628 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
34632 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
34633 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
34637 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
34638 an error and open() fails.
34641 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
34642 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
34643 truncated to zero length.
34646 The file is opened in append mode.
34649 The file is opened for reading only.
34652 The file is opened for writing only.
34655 The file is opened for reading and writing.
34659 Other bits are silently ignored.
34663 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
34667 User has read permission.
34670 User has write permission.
34673 Group has read permission.
34676 Group has write permission.
34679 Others have read permission.
34682 Others have write permission.
34686 Other bits are silently ignored.
34689 @item Return value:
34690 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
34697 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
34700 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
34703 The requested access is not allowed.
34706 @var{pathname} was too long.
34709 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
34712 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
34715 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
34716 write access was requested.
34719 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
34722 No space on device to create the file.
34725 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
34728 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
34732 The call was interrupted by the user.
34738 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
34739 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
34748 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
34750 @item Return value:
34751 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
34757 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
34760 The call was interrupted by the user.
34766 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
34767 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
34772 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
34776 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
34778 @item Return value:
34779 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
34780 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
34781 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
34787 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
34791 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34794 The call was interrupted by the user.
34800 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
34801 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
34806 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
34810 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
34812 @item Return value:
34813 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
34814 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
34821 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
34825 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34828 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
34829 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
34832 No space on device to write the data.
34835 The call was interrupted by the user.
34841 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
34842 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
34847 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
34851 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
34853 @var{flag} is one of:
34857 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
34860 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
34864 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
34868 @item Return value:
34869 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
34870 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
34871 value of -1 is returned.
34877 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
34880 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
34883 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
34886 The call was interrupted by the user.
34892 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
34893 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
34898 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
34902 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
34904 @item Return value:
34905 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
34911 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
34915 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
34918 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
34922 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
34926 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
34927 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
34928 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
34931 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
34934 No access to the file or the path of the file.
34938 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
34941 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
34944 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
34947 The device containing the file has no room for the new
34951 The call was interrupted by the user.
34957 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
34958 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
34963 int unlink(const char *pathname);
34967 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
34969 @item Return value:
34970 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
34976 No access to the file or the path of the file.
34979 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
34982 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
34983 being used by another process.
34986 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34989 @var{pathname} was too long.
34992 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
34995 A component of the path is not a directory.
34998 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
35001 The call was interrupted by the user.
35007 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
35008 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
35009 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
35014 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
35015 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
35019 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
35020 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
35022 @item Return value:
35023 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
35029 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
35032 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
35033 path is an empty string.
35036 A component of the path is not a directory.
35039 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35042 No access to the file or the path of the file.
35045 @var{pathname} was too long.
35048 The call was interrupted by the user.
35054 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
35055 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
35060 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
35064 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
35066 @item Return value:
35067 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
35073 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
35076 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35082 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
35083 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
35088 int isatty(int fd);
35092 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
35094 @item Return value:
35095 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
35101 The call was interrupted by the user.
35106 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
35107 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
35108 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
35109 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
35114 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
35115 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
35120 int system(const char *command);
35124 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
35126 @item Return value:
35127 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
35128 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
35129 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
35130 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
35131 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
35132 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
35133 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
35139 The call was interrupted by the user.
35144 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
35145 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
35146 the host is simplified before it's returned
35147 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
35148 is discarded, and the return value consists
35149 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
35151 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
35152 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
35153 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
35156 @item set remote system-call-allowed
35157 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
35158 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
35159 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
35161 @item show remote system-call-allowed
35162 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
35163 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
35167 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
35168 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
35169 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
35172 * Integral Datatypes::
35174 * Memory Transfer::
35179 @node Integral Datatypes
35180 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
35181 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
35183 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
35184 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
35185 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
35187 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
35188 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
35190 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
35192 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
35193 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
35195 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
35197 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
35198 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
35201 @node Pointer Values
35202 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
35203 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
35205 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
35206 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
35207 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
35208 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
35215 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
35216 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
35217 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
35218 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
35224 @node Memory Transfer
35225 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
35226 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
35228 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
35229 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
35230 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
35231 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
35232 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
35233 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
35234 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
35238 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
35239 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
35241 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
35242 is defined as follows:
35246 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
35247 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
35248 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
35249 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
35250 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
35251 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
35252 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
35253 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
35254 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
35255 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
35256 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
35257 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
35258 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
35262 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
35263 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
35264 structure is of size 64 bytes.
35266 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
35272 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
35275 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
35278 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
35279 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
35284 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
35289 These values have a host and file system dependent
35290 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
35291 support exact timing values.
35294 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
35295 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
35298 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
35299 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
35300 get truncated on the target.
35302 @node struct timeval
35303 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
35304 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
35306 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
35307 is defined as follows:
35311 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
35312 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
35316 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
35317 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
35318 structure is of size 8 bytes.
35321 @subsection Constants
35322 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
35324 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
35325 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
35326 values before and after the call as needed.
35337 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
35338 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
35340 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
35352 @node mode_t Values
35353 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
35354 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
35356 All values are given in octal representation.
35373 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
35374 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
35376 All values are given in decimal representation.
35401 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
35402 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
35405 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
35406 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
35415 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
35416 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
35418 All values are given in decimal representation.
35421 INT_MIN -2147483648
35423 UINT_MAX 4294967295
35424 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
35425 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
35426 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
35429 @node File-I/O Examples
35430 @subsection File-I/O Examples
35431 @cindex file-i/o examples
35433 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
35434 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
35437 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
35438 @emph{request memory read from target}
35441 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
35445 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
35446 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
35449 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35450 @emph{request memory write to target}
35451 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
35452 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
35456 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
35457 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
35460 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35464 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
35468 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35473 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
35477 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35478 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
35482 @node Library List Format
35483 @section Library List Format
35484 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
35486 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
35487 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
35488 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
35489 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
35490 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
35491 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
35492 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35493 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
35494 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
35497 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
35498 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
35499 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
35500 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
35502 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
35503 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
35504 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
35505 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
35506 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
35507 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
35509 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35510 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
35512 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
35513 offset, looks like this:
35517 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
35518 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
35523 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
35524 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
35528 <library name="sharedlib.o">
35529 <section address="0x10000000"/>
35530 <section address="0x20000000"/>
35531 <section address="0x30000000"/>
35536 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
35539 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
35540 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
35541 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
35542 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
35543 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
35544 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
35545 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
35546 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
35547 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
35550 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
35551 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
35552 section for each library.
35554 @node Memory Map Format
35555 @section Memory Map Format
35556 @cindex memory map format
35558 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
35559 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
35562 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35563 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
35564 lists memory regions.
35566 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35567 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
35569 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
35572 <?xml version="1.0"?>
35573 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
35574 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
35575 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
35581 Each region can be either:
35586 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
35590 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
35595 A region of read-only memory:
35598 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
35603 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
35607 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
35608 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
35614 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
35615 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
35616 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
35618 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
35621 <!-- ................................................... -->
35622 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
35623 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
35624 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
35625 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
35626 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
35627 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
35628 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
35629 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
35630 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
35631 and its type, or device. -->
35632 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
35633 start CDATA #REQUIRED
35634 length CDATA #REQUIRED
35635 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
35636 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
35637 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
35638 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
35641 @node Thread List Format
35642 @section Thread List Format
35643 @cindex thread list format
35645 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
35646 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35647 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
35648 the following structure:
35651 <?xml version="1.0"?>
35653 <thread id="id" core="0">
35654 ... description ...
35659 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
35660 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
35661 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
35662 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
35663 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
35665 @include agentexpr.texi
35667 @node Trace File Format
35668 @appendix Trace File Format
35669 @cindex trace file format
35671 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
35672 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
35674 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
35675 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
35676 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
35679 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
35680 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
35681 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
35682 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
35683 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
35686 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
35688 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
35689 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
35690 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
35691 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
35692 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
35693 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
35694 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
35697 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
35700 @item R @var{bytes}
35701 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
35702 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
35703 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
35704 hexadecimal encoding.
35706 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
35707 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
35708 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
35709 @var{length} bytes.
35711 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
35712 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
35713 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
35717 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
35720 @node Target Descriptions
35721 @appendix Target Descriptions
35722 @cindex target descriptions
35724 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
35725 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
35726 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
35728 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
35729 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
35730 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
35731 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
35732 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
35733 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
35734 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
35738 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
35739 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
35741 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
35742 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
35743 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
35745 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
35746 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
35747 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
35750 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
35751 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
35752 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
35753 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
35754 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
35756 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35757 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
35760 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
35761 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
35762 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
35764 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
35767 @node Retrieving Descriptions
35768 @section Retrieving Descriptions
35770 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
35771 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
35772 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
35773 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
35774 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
35775 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
35776 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
35779 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
35780 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
35781 specify a file are:
35784 @cindex set tdesc filename
35785 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
35786 Read the target description from @var{path}.
35788 @cindex unset tdesc filename
35789 @item unset tdesc filename
35790 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
35791 will use the description supplied by the current target.
35793 @cindex show tdesc filename
35794 @item show tdesc filename
35795 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
35799 @node Target Description Format
35800 @section Target Description Format
35801 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
35803 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
35804 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
35805 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
35806 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
35807 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
35808 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
35809 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
35811 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
35812 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
35813 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
35814 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
35815 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
35817 Here is a simple target description:
35820 <target version="1.0">
35821 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
35826 This minimal description only says that the target uses
35827 the x86-64 architecture.
35829 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
35830 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
35831 are explained further below.
35834 <?xml version="1.0"?>
35835 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
35836 <target version="1.0">
35837 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
35838 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
35839 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
35840 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
35845 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
35846 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
35847 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
35848 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
35849 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
35850 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
35851 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
35852 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
35853 the version mismatch.
35855 @subsection Inclusion
35856 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
35859 @cindex <xi:include>
35862 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
35863 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
35864 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
35865 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
35866 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
35869 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
35873 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
35874 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
35875 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
35876 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
35877 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
35878 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
35879 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
35880 original description.
35882 @subsection Architecture
35883 @cindex <architecture>
35885 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
35888 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
35891 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
35892 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
35895 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
35897 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
35898 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
35900 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
35903 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
35906 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
35907 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
35909 @subsection Compatible Architecture
35910 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
35912 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
35913 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
35915 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
35918 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
35921 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
35922 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
35924 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
35925 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
35926 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
35927 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
35928 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
35929 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
35930 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
35933 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
35934 <compatible>spu</compatible>
35937 @subsection Features
35940 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
35941 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
35942 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
35946 <feature name="@var{name}">
35947 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
35953 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
35954 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
35955 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
35956 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
35960 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
35961 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
35962 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
35963 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
35964 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
35966 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
35967 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
35968 Types must be defined before they are used.
35971 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
35972 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
35973 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
35977 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
35981 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
35982 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
35983 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
35984 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
35987 <union id="@var{id}">
35988 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
35994 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
35995 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
35996 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
35997 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
35998 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
35999 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
36000 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
36001 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
36004 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
36005 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
36010 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
36011 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
36014 <struct id="@var{id}">
36015 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
36021 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
36022 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
36023 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
36024 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
36028 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
36029 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
36034 @subsection Registers
36037 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
36040 <reg name="@var{name}"
36041 bitsize="@var{size}"
36042 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
36043 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
36044 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
36045 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
36049 The components are as follows:
36054 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
36057 The register's size, in bits.
36060 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
36061 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
36062 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
36063 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
36064 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
36065 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
36066 in order of increasing register number.
36069 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
36070 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
36071 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
36072 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
36076 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
36077 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
36078 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
36079 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
36080 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
36081 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
36084 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
36085 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
36086 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
36087 in @code{info registers}.
36091 @node Predefined Target Types
36092 @section Predefined Target Types
36093 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
36095 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
36096 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
36097 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
36098 types. The currently supported types are:
36107 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
36114 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
36118 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
36119 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
36120 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
36121 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
36122 may be marked as data pointers.
36125 Single precision IEEE floating point.
36128 Double precision IEEE floating point.
36131 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
36134 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
36137 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
36140 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
36144 @node Standard Target Features
36145 @section Standard Target Features
36146 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
36148 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
36149 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
36150 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
36151 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
36152 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
36153 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
36154 can recognize them.
36156 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
36157 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
36158 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
36159 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
36160 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
36161 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
36162 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
36163 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
36165 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
36166 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
36167 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
36169 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
36170 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
36171 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
36172 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
36174 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
36175 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
36176 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
36183 * PowerPC Features::
36188 @subsection ARM Features
36189 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
36191 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
36193 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
36194 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
36196 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
36197 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
36198 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
36201 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
36202 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
36204 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
36205 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
36206 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
36207 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
36209 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
36210 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
36211 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
36212 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
36213 halves of the double-precision registers.
36215 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
36216 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
36217 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
36218 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
36219 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
36220 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
36222 @node i386 Features
36223 @subsection i386 Features
36224 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
36226 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
36227 targets. It should describe the following registers:
36231 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
36233 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
36235 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
36236 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
36238 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
36240 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
36241 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
36244 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
36246 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
36247 describe registers:
36251 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
36253 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
36258 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
36259 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
36260 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
36264 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
36266 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
36269 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
36270 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
36272 @node MIPS Features
36273 @subsection MIPS Features
36274 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
36276 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
36277 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
36278 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
36281 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
36282 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
36283 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36285 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
36286 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
36287 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
36288 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36290 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
36291 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
36292 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
36294 @node M68K Features
36295 @subsection M68K Features
36296 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
36299 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
36300 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
36301 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
36302 One of those features must be always present.
36303 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
36304 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
36305 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
36306 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
36308 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
36309 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
36310 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
36314 @node PowerPC Features
36315 @subsection PowerPC Features
36316 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
36318 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
36319 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
36320 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
36321 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36323 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
36324 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
36326 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
36327 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
36330 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
36331 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
36332 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
36333 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
36334 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
36335 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
36337 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
36338 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
36339 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
36340 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
36341 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
36342 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
36345 @node Operating System Information
36346 @appendix Operating System Information
36347 @cindex operating system information
36353 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
36354 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
36355 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
36356 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
36357 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
36358 on a different aspect of target.
36360 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
36361 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
36362 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
36363 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
36366 @appendixsection Process list
36367 @cindex operating system information, process list
36369 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
36370 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
36371 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
36372 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
36374 An example document is:
36377 <?xml version="1.0"?>
36378 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
36379 <osdata type="processes">
36381 <column name="pid">1</column>
36382 <column name="user">root</column>
36383 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
36384 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
36389 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
36390 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
36391 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
36392 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
36393 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
36394 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
36395 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
36399 @node GNU Free Documentation License
36400 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36409 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
36411 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
36412 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
36413 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
36414 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
36415 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
36416 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
36417 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
36418 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
36419 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
36421 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.